]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(gdb_pvec_type): A dummy variable for GDB's sake.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
187
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
189
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
194
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
196
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
201
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
203
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
205
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
207
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
213
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
215
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
217
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
220
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
222
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
226
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
228
229 /* Mouse movement.
230
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
235
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
237
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
248
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
250
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
253 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
254
255 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
256
257 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
258 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
259 an ordinary motion.
260
261 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
262 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
263 event. */
264
265 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
266
267 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
268 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
269 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
270 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
271 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
272 it's somewhat accurate. */
273
274 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
275
276 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
277 events. */
278
279 #ifdef __STDC__
280 static int volatile input_signal_count;
281 #else
282 static int input_signal_count;
283 #endif
284
285 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
286
287 static int x_noop_count;
288
289 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
290
291 extern char **initial_argv;
292 extern int initial_argc;
293
294 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
295
296 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
297
298 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
299
300 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
301
302 extern int errno;
303
304 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
305
306 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
307
308 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
309
310 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
311 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
312 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
313
314 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
315 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
316
317 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
318 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
319
320 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
321 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
322 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
323 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
324 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
325 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
326 unsigned));
327 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
328 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
329 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
330 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
331 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
332 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
333 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
334 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
335 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
336 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
339 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
340 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
346 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
349 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
350 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
351 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
352 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
353 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
354 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
355 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
356 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
357 enum text_cursor_kinds));
358
359 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
360 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
361 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
362 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
363 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
364 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
365 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
366 enum scroll_bar_part *,
367 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
368 unsigned long *));
369 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
372 int *, struct input_event *));
373
374
375 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
376
377 static void
378 x_flush (f)
379 struct frame *f;
380 {
381 BLOCK_INPUT;
382 if (f == NULL)
383 {
384 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
385 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
386 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
387 }
388 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
389 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
391 }
392
393
394 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
395 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
396 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
397 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
398 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
399 performance. */
400
401 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
402
403 \f
404 /***********************************************************************
405 Debugging
406 ***********************************************************************/
407
408 #if 0
409
410 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
411 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
412
413 struct record
414 {
415 char *locus;
416 int type;
417 };
418
419 struct record event_record[100];
420
421 int event_record_index;
422
423 record_event (locus, type)
424 char *locus;
425 int type;
426 {
427 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
428 event_record_index = 0;
429
430 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
431 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
432 event_record_index++;
433 }
434
435 #endif /* 0 */
436
437
438 \f
439 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
440
441 struct x_display_info *
442 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
443 Display *dpy;
444 {
445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
446
447 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
448 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
449 return dpyinfo;
450
451 return 0;
452 }
453
454
455 \f
456 /***********************************************************************
457 Starting and ending an update
458 ***********************************************************************/
459
460 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
461 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
462 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
463 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
464 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
465
466 static void
467 x_update_begin (f)
468 struct frame *f;
469 {
470 /* Nothing to do. */
471 }
472
473
474 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
475 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
476 position of W. */
477
478 static void
479 x_update_window_begin (w)
480 struct window *w;
481 {
482 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
483 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
484
485 updated_window = w;
486 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
487
488 BLOCK_INPUT;
489
490 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
491 {
492 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
493 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
494
495 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
496 highlighting. */
497 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
498 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
499
500 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
501 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
502 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
503 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
504 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
505 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
506
507 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
508 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
509 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
510 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
511 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
512 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
513 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
514 {
515 int i;
516
517 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
518 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
519 break;
520
521 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
522 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
523 }
524 #endif /* 0 */
525 }
526
527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
528 }
529
530
531 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
532
533 static void
534 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
535 struct window *w;
536 int x, y0, y1;
537 {
538 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
539 struct face *face;
540
541 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
542 if (face)
543 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
544 face->foreground);
545
546 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
547 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
548 }
549
550 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
551
552 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
553 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
554
555 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
556 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
557 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
558
559 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
560 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
561 here. */
562
563 static void
564 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
565 struct window *w;
566 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
567 {
568 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
569
570 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
571 {
572 BLOCK_INPUT;
573
574 if (cursor_on_p)
575 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
576 output_cursor.vpos,
577 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
578
579 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
580 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
581
582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
583 }
584
585 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
586 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
587 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
588 {
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
591 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
592 }
593
594 updated_window = NULL;
595 }
596
597
598 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
599 update_end. */
600
601 static void
602 x_update_end (f)
603 struct frame *f;
604 {
605 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
606 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
607
608 #ifndef XFlush
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
610 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
612 #endif
613 }
614
615
616 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
617 complete update has been performed. The global variable
618 updated_window is not available here. */
619
620 static void
621 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
622 struct frame *f;
623 {
624 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
625 {
626 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
627
628 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
629 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
630 {
631 BLOCK_INPUT;
632 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
633 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
636 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
638 }
639 }
640 }
641
642
643 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
644 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
645 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
646 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
647 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
648 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
649
650 static void
651 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
652 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
653 {
654 struct window *w = updated_window;
655 struct frame *f;
656 int width, height;
657
658 xassert (w);
659
660 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
661 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
662
663 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
664 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
665 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
666 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
667 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
668 overhead is very small. */
669 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
670 && desired_row->full_width_p
671 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
672 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
673 width != 0)
674 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
675 height > 0))
676 {
677 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
678
679 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
680 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
681 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
682 y -= width;
683
684 BLOCK_INPUT;
685 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
686 0, y, width, height, False);
687 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
688 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
689 y, width, height, False);
690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
691 }
692 }
693
694 static void
695 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
696 struct window *w;
697 struct glyph_row *row;
698 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
699 {
700 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
701 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
702 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
703 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
704 struct face *face = p->face;
705 int rowY;
706
707 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
708 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
709 if (p->y < rowY)
710 {
711 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
712 visible last row. */
713 int oldY = row->y;
714 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
715 row->visible_height = p->h;
716 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
718 row->y = oldY;
719 row->visible_height = oldVH;
720 }
721 else
722 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
723
724 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
725 {
726 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
727 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
728 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
729 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
730 if (face->stipple)
731 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
732 else
733 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
734
735 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
736 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
737
738 if (!face->stipple)
739 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
740 }
741
742 if (p->which)
743 {
744 unsigned char *bits;
745 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
746 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
747 XGCValues gcv;
748
749 if (p->wd > 8)
750 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
751 else
752 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
753
754 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
755 by the server. */
756 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
757 (p->cursor_p
758 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
759 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
760 : face->foreground),
761 face->background, depth);
762
763 if (p->overlay_p)
764 {
765 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
766 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
767 bits, p->wd, p->h,
768 1, 0, 1);
769 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
770 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
771 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
772 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
773 }
774
775 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
776 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
777 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
778
779 if (p->overlay_p)
780 {
781 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
782 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
783 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
784 }
785 }
786
787 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
788 }
789
790 \f
791
792 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
793 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
794 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
795 rarely happens). */
796
797 static void
798 XTset_terminal_modes ()
799 {
800 }
801
802 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
803 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
804
805 static void
806 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
807 {
808 }
809
810
811 \f
812 /***********************************************************************
813 Display Iterator
814 ***********************************************************************/
815
816 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
817
818 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
819
820
821 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
822 is not contained in the font. */
823
824 static XCharStruct *
825 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
826 XFontStruct *font;
827 XChar2b *char2b;
828 int font_type; /* unused on X */
829 {
830 /* The result metric information. */
831 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
832
833 xassert (font && char2b);
834
835 if (font->per_char != NULL)
836 {
837 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
838 {
839 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
840 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
841 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
842 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
843 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
844 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
845 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
846 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
847 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
848 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
849 }
850 else
851 {
852 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
853 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
854 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
855 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
856
857 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
858 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
859
860 where:
861
862 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
863 / = integer division
864 \ = integer modulus */
865 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
866 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
867 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
868 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
869 {
870 pcm = (font->per_char
871 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
872 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
873 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
874 }
875 }
876 }
877 else
878 {
879 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
880 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
881 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
882 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
883 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
884 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
885 }
886
887 return ((pcm == NULL
888 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
889 ? NULL : pcm);
890 }
891
892
893 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
894 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
895
896 static int
897 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
898 int c;
899 XChar2b *char2b;
900 struct font_info *font_info;
901 int *two_byte_p;
902 {
903 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
904 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
905
906 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
907 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
908 fixed encoding. */
909 if (font_info->font_encoder)
910 {
911 /* It's a program. */
912 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
913
914 check_ccl_update (ccl);
915 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
916 {
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
919 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
920 }
921 else
922 {
923 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
924 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
925 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
926 }
927
928 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
929
930 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
931 program. */
932 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
933 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
934 else
935 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
936 }
937 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
938 {
939 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
940 encoding numbers. */
941 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
942
943 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
944 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
945 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
946
947 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
948 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
949 }
950
951 if (two_byte_p)
952 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
953
954 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
955 }
956
957
958 \f
959 /***********************************************************************
960 Glyph display
961 ***********************************************************************/
962
963
964
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
968 int));
969 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
978 unsigned long *, double, int));
979 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
980 double, int, unsigned long));
981 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
985 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
986 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
987 int, int, int));
988 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
989 int, int, int, int, int, int,
990 XRectangle *));
991 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
992 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
993
994 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
995 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
996 #endif
997
998
999 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1000 face. */
1001
1002 static void
1003 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1004 struct glyph_string *s;
1005 {
1006 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1007 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1009 && !s->cmp)
1010 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1011 else
1012 {
1013 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1014 XGCValues xgcv;
1015 unsigned long mask;
1016
1017 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1019
1020 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1021 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1024 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1025 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1026 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1027
1028 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1029 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1030 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1031 {
1032 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1033 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1034 }
1035
1036 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1037 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1038 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1039 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1040
1041 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1042 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1043 mask, &xgcv);
1044 else
1045 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1046 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1047
1048 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1049 }
1050 }
1051
1052
1053 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1054
1055 static void
1056 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1057 struct glyph_string *s;
1058 {
1059 int face_id;
1060 struct face *face;
1061
1062 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1063 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1064 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1065 if (face == NULL)
1066 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1067
1068 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1069 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1070 else
1071 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1072 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1073 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1074
1075 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1076 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1077 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1078 else
1079 {
1080 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1081 but font FONT. */
1082 XGCValues xgcv;
1083 unsigned long mask;
1084
1085 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1086 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1087 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1088 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1089 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1090 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1091
1092 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1093 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1094 mask, &xgcv);
1095 else
1096 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1097 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1098
1099 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1100 }
1101
1102 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1103 }
1104
1105
1106 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1107 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1108 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1109
1110 static INLINE void
1111 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1112 struct glyph_string *s;
1113 {
1114 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1115 }
1116
1117
1118 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1119 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1120 pattern. */
1121
1122 static INLINE void
1123 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1124 struct glyph_string *s;
1125 {
1126 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1127
1128 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1129 {
1130 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1131 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1132 }
1133 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1134 {
1135 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1136 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1137 }
1138 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1139 {
1140 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1141 s->stippled_p = 0;
1142 }
1143 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1144 {
1145 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 }
1148 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1149 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1150 {
1151 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1152 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1153 }
1154 else
1155 {
1156 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1157 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1158 }
1159
1160 /* GC must have been set. */
1161 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1162 }
1163
1164
1165 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1166 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1167
1168 static INLINE void
1169 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1170 struct glyph_string *s;
1171 {
1172 XRectangle r;
1173 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1174 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1175 }
1176
1177
1178 /* RIF:
1179 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1180 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1181
1182 static void
1183 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1184 struct glyph_string *s;
1185 {
1186 if (s->cmp == NULL
1187 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1188 {
1189 XCharStruct cs;
1190 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1191 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1192 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1193 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1194 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1195 }
1196 }
1197
1198
1199 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1200
1201 static INLINE void
1202 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1204 int x, y, w, h;
1205 {
1206 XGCValues xgcv;
1207 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1208 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1209 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1210 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1211 }
1212
1213
1214 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1215 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1216 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1217 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1218 contains the first component of a composition. */
1219
1220 static void
1221 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1222 struct glyph_string *s;
1223 int force_p;
1224 {
1225 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1226 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1227 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1228 {
1229 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1230
1231 if (s->stippled_p)
1232 {
1233 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1234 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1235 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1236 s->y + box_line_width,
1237 s->background_width,
1238 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1239 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1240 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1241 }
1242 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1243 || s->font_not_found_p
1244 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1245 || force_p)
1246 {
1247 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1248 s->background_width,
1249 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1250 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1251 }
1252 }
1253 }
1254
1255
1256 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1257
1258 static void
1259 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1260 struct glyph_string *s;
1261 {
1262 int i, x;
1263
1264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1265 of S to the right of that box line. */
1266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1268 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1269 else
1270 x = s->x;
1271
1272 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1273 loaded. */
1274 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1275 {
1276 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1277 {
1278 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1279 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1280 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1281 s->height - 1);
1282 x += g->pixel_width;
1283 }
1284 }
1285 else
1286 {
1287 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1288 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1289
1290 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1291 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1292
1293 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1294 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1295 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1296 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1297
1298 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1299 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1300 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1301 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1302 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1303 if (s->for_overlaps
1304 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1305 {
1306 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1307 if (s->two_byte_p)
1308 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1309 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1310 else
1311 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1313 }
1314 else
1315 {
1316 if (s->two_byte_p)
1317 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1318 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1319 else
1320 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1321 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1322 }
1323
1324 if (s->face->overstrike)
1325 {
1326 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1327 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1328 if (s->two_byte_p)
1329 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1330 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1331 else
1332 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1333 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1334 }
1335 }
1336 }
1337
1338 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1339
1340 static void
1341 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1342 struct glyph_string *s;
1343 {
1344 int i, x;
1345
1346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1347 of S to the right of that box line. */
1348 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1350 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1351 else
1352 x = s->x;
1353
1354 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1355 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1356 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1357 this composition. */
1358
1359 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1360 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1361 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1362 {
1363 if (s->gidx == 0)
1364 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1365 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1366 }
1367 else
1368 {
1369 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1370 {
1371 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1372 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1373 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1374 s->char2b + i, 1);
1375 if (s->face->overstrike)
1376 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1377 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1378 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1379 s->char2b + i, 1);
1380 }
1381 }
1382 }
1383
1384
1385 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1386
1387 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1388 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1389 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1390 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1391 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1392
1393
1394 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1395 cannot be determined. */
1396
1397 static struct frame *
1398 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1399 Widget widget;
1400 {
1401 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1402 Lisp_Object tail;
1403 struct frame *f;
1404
1405 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1406
1407 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1408 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1409 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1410 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1411 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1412 widget = XtParent (widget);
1413
1414 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1415 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1416 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1417 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1418 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1419 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1420 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1421 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1422 return f;
1423
1424 abort ();
1425 }
1426
1427
1428 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1429 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1430 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1431 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1432
1433 int
1434 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1435 Widget widget;
1436 Colormap cmap;
1437 XColor *color;
1438 {
1439 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1440 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1441 }
1442
1443
1444 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1445 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1446 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1447 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1448 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1449 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1450
1451 int
1452 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1453 Widget widget;
1454 Display *display;
1455 Colormap cmap;
1456 unsigned long *pixel;
1457 double factor;
1458 int delta;
1459 {
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1462 }
1463
1464
1465 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1466 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1467
1468 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1469 {
1470 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1471 sizeof (Screen *)},
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1473 sizeof (Colormap)}
1474 };
1475
1476
1477 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1479
1480 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1481
1482
1483 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1484
1485 DPY is the display we are working on.
1486
1487 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1488 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1489 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1490 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1491
1492 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1493 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1494
1495 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1496 we allocated the color or not.
1497
1498 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1499
1500 static Boolean
1501 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1502 Display *dpy;
1503 XrmValue *args;
1504 Cardinal *nargs;
1505 XrmValue *from, *to;
1506 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1507 {
1508 Screen *screen;
1509 Colormap cmap;
1510 Pixel pixel;
1511 String color_name;
1512 XColor color;
1513
1514 if (*nargs != 2)
1515 {
1516 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1517 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1518 "XtToolkitError",
1519 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1520 return False;
1521 }
1522
1523 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1524 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1525 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1526
1527 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1528 {
1529 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1530 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1531 }
1532 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1533 {
1534 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1535 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1536 }
1537 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1538 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1539 {
1540 pixel = color.pixel;
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1542 }
1543 else
1544 {
1545 String params[1];
1546 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1547
1548 params[0] = color_name;
1549 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1550 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1551 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1552 params, &nparams);
1553 return False;
1554 }
1555
1556 if (to->addr != NULL)
1557 {
1558 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1559 {
1560 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1561 return False;
1562 }
1563
1564 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1565 }
1566 else
1567 {
1568 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1569 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1570 }
1571
1572 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1573 return True;
1574 }
1575
1576
1577 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1578 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1579 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1580
1581 APP is the application context in which we work.
1582
1583 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1584 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1585 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1586
1587 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1588
1589 static void
1590 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1591 XtAppContext app;
1592 XrmValuePtr to;
1593 XtPointer closure;
1594 XrmValuePtr args;
1595 Cardinal *nargs;
1596 {
1597 if (*nargs != 2)
1598 {
1599 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1600 "XtToolkitError",
1601 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1602 NULL, NULL);
1603 }
1604 else if (closure != NULL)
1605 {
1606 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1607 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1608 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1609 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1610 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1611 }
1612 }
1613
1614
1615 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1616
1617
1618 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1619 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1620 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1621 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1622
1623 static const XColor *
1624 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1625 Display *dpy;
1626 int *ncells;
1627 {
1628 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1629
1630 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1631 {
1632 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1633 int i;
1634
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1636 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1637 dpyinfo->color_cells
1638 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1639 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1640
1641 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1642 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1643
1644 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1645 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1646 }
1647
1648 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1649 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1650 }
1651
1652
1653 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1654 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1655
1656 void
1657 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1658 struct frame *f;
1659 XColor *colors;
1660 int ncolors;
1661 {
1662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1663
1664 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1665 {
1666 int i;
1667 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1668 {
1669 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1670 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1671 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1672 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1673 }
1674 }
1675 else
1676 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1677 }
1678
1679
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1681 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1682
1683 void
1684 x_query_color (f, color)
1685 struct frame *f;
1686 XColor *color;
1687 {
1688 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1689 }
1690
1691
1692 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1693 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1694 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1695 allocated. */
1696
1697 static int
1698 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1699 Display *dpy;
1700 Colormap cmap;
1701 XColor *color;
1702 {
1703 int rc;
1704
1705 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1706 if (rc == 0)
1707 {
1708 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1709 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1710 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1711 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1712 int nearest, i;
1713 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1714 int ncells;
1715 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1716
1717 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1718 {
1719 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1720 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1721 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1722 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1723
1724 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1725 {
1726 nearest = i;
1727 nearest_delta = delta;
1728 }
1729 }
1730
1731 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1732 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1733 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1734 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1735 }
1736 else
1737 {
1738 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1739 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1740 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1742 XColor *cached_color;
1743
1744 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1745 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1746 (cached_color->red != color->red
1747 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1748 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1749 {
1750 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1751 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1752 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1753 }
1754 }
1755
1756 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1757 if (rc)
1758 register_color (color->pixel);
1759 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1760
1761 return rc;
1762 }
1763
1764
1765 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1766 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1767 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1768 allocated. */
1769
1770 int
1771 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1772 struct frame *f;
1773 Colormap cmap;
1774 XColor *color;
1775 {
1776 gamma_correct (f, color);
1777 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1778 }
1779
1780
1781 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1782 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1783 get color reference counts right. */
1784
1785 unsigned long
1786 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1787 struct frame *f;
1788 unsigned long pixel;
1789 {
1790 XColor color;
1791
1792 color.pixel = pixel;
1793 BLOCK_INPUT;
1794 x_query_color (f, &color);
1795 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1797 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1798 register_color (pixel);
1799 #endif
1800 return color.pixel;
1801 }
1802
1803
1804 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1805 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1806 get color reference counts right. */
1807
1808 unsigned long
1809 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1810 Display *dpy;
1811 Colormap cmap;
1812 unsigned long pixel;
1813 {
1814 XColor color;
1815
1816 color.pixel = pixel;
1817 BLOCK_INPUT;
1818 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1821 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1822 register_color (pixel);
1823 #endif
1824 return color.pixel;
1825 }
1826
1827
1828 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1829 boosted.
1830
1831 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1832 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1833 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1834 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1835 use an additional additive factor.
1836
1837 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1838 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1839 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1840
1841
1842 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1843 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1844 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1845 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1846 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1847 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1848
1849 static int
1850 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1851 struct frame *f;
1852 Display *display;
1853 Colormap cmap;
1854 unsigned long *pixel;
1855 double factor;
1856 int delta;
1857 {
1858 XColor color, new;
1859 long bright;
1860 int success_p;
1861
1862 /* Get RGB color values. */
1863 color.pixel = *pixel;
1864 x_query_color (f, &color);
1865
1866 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1867 xassert (factor >= 0);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1871
1872 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1873 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1874
1875 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1876 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1877 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1878 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1879 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1880 {
1881 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1882 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1883 /* The additive adjustment. */
1884 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1885
1886 if (factor < 1)
1887 {
1888 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1889 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1890 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1891 }
1892 else
1893 {
1894 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1895 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1896 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1897 }
1898 }
1899
1900 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1901 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1902 if (success_p)
1903 {
1904 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1905 {
1906 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1907 delta to the RGB values. */
1908 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1909
1910 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1911 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1912 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1913 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1914 }
1915 else
1916 success_p = 1;
1917 *pixel = new.pixel;
1918 }
1919
1920 return success_p;
1921 }
1922
1923
1924 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1925 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1926 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1927 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1928 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1929 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1930
1931 static void
1932 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1933 struct frame *f;
1934 struct relief *relief;
1935 double factor;
1936 int delta;
1937 unsigned long default_pixel;
1938 {
1939 XGCValues xgcv;
1940 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1942 unsigned long pixel;
1943 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1944 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1946 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1947
1948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1949 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1950
1951 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1952 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1953 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1954 if (relief->gc
1955 && relief->allocated_p)
1956 {
1957 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1958 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1959 }
1960
1961 /* Allocate new color. */
1962 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1963 pixel = background;
1964 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1965 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1966 {
1967 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1968 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1969 }
1970
1971 if (relief->gc == 0)
1972 {
1973 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1974 mask |= GCStipple;
1975 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1976 }
1977 else
1978 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1979 }
1980
1981
1982 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1983
1984 static void
1985 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1986 struct glyph_string *s;
1987 {
1988 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1989 unsigned long color;
1990
1991 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1992 color = s->face->box_color;
1993 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1994 && s->img->pixmap
1995 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1996 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1997 else
1998 {
1999 XGCValues xgcv;
2000
2001 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2002 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2003 color = xgcv.background;
2004 }
2005
2006 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2007 || color != di->relief_background)
2008 {
2009 di->relief_background = color;
2010 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2011 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2012 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2013 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2014 }
2015 }
2016
2017
2018 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2019 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2020 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2021 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2022 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2023 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2024 when drawing. */
2025
2026 static void
2027 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2028 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2029 struct frame *f;
2030 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2031 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2032 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2033 {
2034 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2035 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2036 int i;
2037 GC gc;
2038
2039 if (raised_p)
2040 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2041 else
2042 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2043 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2044
2045 /* Top. */
2046 if (top_p)
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2050 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2051
2052 /* Left. */
2053 if (left_p)
2054 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2057
2058 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2059 if (raised_p)
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2061 else
2062 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2063 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2064
2065 /* Bottom. */
2066 if (bot_p)
2067 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2070 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2071
2072 /* Right. */
2073 if (right_p)
2074 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2075 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2076 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2077
2078 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2079 }
2080
2081
2082 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2083 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2084 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2085 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2086 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2087 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2088
2089 static void
2090 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2091 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2092 struct glyph_string *s;
2093 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2094 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2095 {
2096 XGCValues xgcv;
2097
2098 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2099 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2100 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2101
2102 /* Top. */
2103 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2104 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2105
2106 /* Left. */
2107 if (left_p)
2108 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2109 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2110
2111 /* Bottom. */
2112 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2113 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2114
2115 /* Right. */
2116 if (right_p)
2117 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2118 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2119
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2121 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2122 }
2123
2124
2125 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2126
2127 static void
2128 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2129 struct glyph_string *s;
2130 {
2131 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2132 int left_p, right_p;
2133 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2134 XRectangle clip_rect;
2135
2136 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2137 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2138 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2182 {
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2185
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2192
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2199
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2201 {
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2203 {
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2213
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2219
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2229 }
2230 else
2231 {
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2243
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2251 {
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2258 }
2259 }
2260 }
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2265 }
2266
2267
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2269
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2273 {
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2278
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2285
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2292
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2295 {
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2298 }
2299 else
2300 {
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2303 }
2304
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2309
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2322
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2327 {
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2330
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2337
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2344
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2346 {
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2348 {
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2357
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2363
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 }
2369 else
2370 {
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2374
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2382 {
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2388 }
2389 }
2390 }
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2395 }
2396
2397
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2400
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2405 {
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2407 {
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2412 }
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2415 }
2416
2417
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2419
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2423 |
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2426 | |
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2429
2430 */
2431
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2435 {
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 {
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2459 {
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2470
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 {
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2483 }
2484 else
2485 {
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2493 }
2494 }
2495 else
2496 {
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2499
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2503
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2506
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2508 }
2509
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2511 }
2512
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2515 {
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2521 }
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2524
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2530 }
2531
2532
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2534
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2538 {
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2541
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 {
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2548
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2551
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2554 {
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2559
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2562 {
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2565 }
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2568
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2571
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2573 {
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2578 }
2579 else
2580 {
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2586 }
2587 }
2588 }
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2592
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2594 }
2595
2596
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2598
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2602 {
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2604
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2609 {
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2614 }
2615
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2618
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2625
2626 {
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2632 }
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2635
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2637 {
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2641
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2645
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2653
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2661
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2664 }
2665
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2667 {
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2670 {
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2673
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2677
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2682
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2685
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2693
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2698 {
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2705 }
2706 }
2707
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2710 {
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2712
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2717 {
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2724 }
2725 }
2726
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2729 {
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2732
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2737 {
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2744 }
2745 }
2746
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2757
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2762 {
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2767 }
2768
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2771
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2775 {
2776 abort ();
2777 }
2778
2779
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2782
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2790 {
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2793 }
2794
2795
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2798
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2801 {
2802 struct frame *f;
2803
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2808
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2814
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2819
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2823
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2825
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2827 }
2828
2829
2830 \f
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2832
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2835
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2837
2838
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2841
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2845 {
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2849 {
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2853 }
2854
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2856 {
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2860 }
2861
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2866
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2870 }
2871
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2875 {
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2877
2878 {
2879 GC gc;
2880
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2883 {
2884 XGCValues values;
2885
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2889
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2892 }
2893
2894 {
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2902
2903 int width;
2904
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2908 {
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2912
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2916
2917 default:
2918 break;
2919 }
2920
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2922
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2925 {
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2936 }
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2942
2943 x_flush (f);
2944
2945 {
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2947
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2949
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2954
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2958 {
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2961
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2963
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2967
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2971
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2974 }
2975 }
2976
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2979 {
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2990 }
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2996
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
2999 }
3000 }
3001
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3003 }
3004
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3006
3007
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3009
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3012 {
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3014
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3016 {
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3022 {
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3027 }
3028 }
3029 }
3030
3031 \f
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3036
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3040 {
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3042 }
3043
3044
3045 \f
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3049
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3052
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3056 {
3057 abort ();
3058 }
3059
3060
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3062
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3067 {
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3070
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3075
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3079
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3081 {
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3088 }
3089 else
3090 {
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3097 }
3098
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3100
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3104
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3111
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3113 }
3114
3115
3116 \f
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3120
3121 \f
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3125 {
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3135 }
3136
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3140 {
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3150 }
3151
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3157
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3162 {
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3164
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3166 {
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3170
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3173
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3181
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3186 }
3187
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3194
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3202 {
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3204 {
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3206 {
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3209
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3215 {
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3218 }
3219 }
3220
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3222
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3227 }
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3229 {
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3231
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3233 {
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3236 }
3237
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3242 }
3243 }
3244
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3247
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3249
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3255 {
3256 struct frame *frame;
3257
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3261
3262 switch (event->type)
3263 {
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3266 {
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3270
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3277 }
3278 break;
3279
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3287 }
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3292
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3296 {
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3298 }
3299
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3303
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3307
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3311 {
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3313 }
3314
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 {
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3320
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3322 {
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3328 {
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3331 }
3332 }
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3335
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3337 {
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3342 }
3343 }
3344
3345
3346 \f
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3348
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3353 {
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3358
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3364
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3371
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3376
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3379 {
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3382
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3384 {
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3387 {
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3389
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3393
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3395 {
3396 int code_col;
3397
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3399 {
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3401
3402 switch (sym)
3403 {
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3409
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3415
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3423
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3431
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444 }
3445
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3448 {
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3451 }
3452
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3456 {
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3458 }
3459
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3462 }
3463
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3466
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3471 {
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3477
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3486
3487
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3494 }
3495
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3500 {
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3505
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3507
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3516
3517
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3524 }
3525
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3527
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3531 {
3532 char *value;
3533
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3537
3538 return value;
3539 }
3540
3541
3542 \f
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3544
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3546
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3549
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 {
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3566
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3572 }
3573
3574 \f
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3577
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3582
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3585
3586 static int
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3590 {
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3594
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3596 {
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3600 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3601 return 1;
3602 }
3603
3604
3605 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3606 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3607 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3608 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3609 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3610 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3611 {
3612 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3613 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3614 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3615 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3616 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3617 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3618 return 1;
3619 }
3620
3621 return 0;
3622 }
3623
3624 \f
3625 /************************************************************************
3626 Mouse Face
3627 ************************************************************************/
3628
3629 static void
3630 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3631 {
3632 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3633 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3634 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3635 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3636 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3637 }
3638
3639
3640
3641 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3642 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3643
3644 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3645 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3646 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3647 position on the scroll bar.
3648
3649 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3650 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3651 the mouse is over.
3652
3653 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3654 was at this position.
3655
3656 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3657
3658 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3659 movement. */
3660
3661 static void
3662 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3663 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3664 int insist;
3665 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3666 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3667 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3668 unsigned long *time;
3669 {
3670 FRAME_PTR f1;
3671
3672 BLOCK_INPUT;
3673
3674 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3675 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3676 else
3677 {
3678 Window root;
3679 int root_x, root_y;
3680
3681 Window dummy_window;
3682 int dummy;
3683
3684 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3685
3686 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3687 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3688 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3689 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3690
3691 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3692
3693 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3694 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3695 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3696
3697 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3698 &root,
3699
3700 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3701 a different screen. */
3702 &dummy_window,
3703
3704 /* The position on that root window. */
3705 &root_x, &root_y,
3706
3707 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3708 &dummy, &dummy,
3709
3710 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3711 we don't care. */
3712 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3713
3714 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3715 containing the pointer. */
3716 {
3717 Window win, child;
3718 int win_x, win_y;
3719 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3720 int count;
3721
3722 win = root;
3723
3724 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3725 structure is changing at the same time this function
3726 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3727
3728 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3729
3730 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3731 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3732 {
3733 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3734 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3735 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3736
3737 /* From-window, to-window. */
3738 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3739
3740 /* From-position, to-position. */
3741 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3742
3743 /* Child of win. */
3744 &child);
3745 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3746 }
3747 else
3748 {
3749 while (1)
3750 {
3751 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3752
3753 /* From-window, to-window. */
3754 root, win,
3755
3756 /* From-position, to-position. */
3757 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3758
3759 /* Child of win. */
3760 &child);
3761
3762 if (child == None || child == win)
3763 break;
3764
3765 win = child;
3766 parent_x = win_x;
3767 parent_y = win_y;
3768 }
3769
3770 /* Now we know that:
3771 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3772 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3773 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3774 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3775 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3776 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3777 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3778 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3779 never use them in that case.) */
3780
3781 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3782 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3783
3784 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3785 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3786 on the frame. */
3787 if (f1 != NULL
3788 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3789 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3790 f1 = NULL;
3791 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3792 }
3793
3794 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3795 f1 = 0;
3796
3797 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3798
3799 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3800 if (! f1)
3801 {
3802 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3803
3804 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3805
3806 if (bar)
3807 {
3808 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3809 win_x = parent_x;
3810 win_y = parent_y;
3811 }
3812 }
3813
3814 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3815 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3816
3817 if (f1)
3818 {
3819 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3820 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3821 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3822 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3823 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3824 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3825 the frame are divided into. */
3826
3827 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3828 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3829
3830 *bar_window = Qnil;
3831 *part = 0;
3832 *fp = f1;
3833 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3834 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3835 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3836 }
3837 }
3838 }
3839
3840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3841 }
3842
3843
3844 \f
3845 /***********************************************************************
3846 Scroll bars
3847 ***********************************************************************/
3848
3849 /* Scroll bar support. */
3850
3851 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3852 manages it.
3853 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3854 bits. */
3855
3856 static struct scroll_bar *
3857 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3858 Display *display;
3859 Window window_id;
3860 {
3861 Lisp_Object tail;
3862
3863 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3864 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3865 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3866
3867 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3868 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3869 tail = XCDR (tail))
3870 {
3871 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3872
3873 frame = XCAR (tail);
3874 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3875 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3876 abort ();
3877
3878 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3879 right window ID. */
3880 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3881 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3882 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3883 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3884 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3885 condemned = Qnil,
3886 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3887 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3888 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3889 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3890 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3891 }
3892
3893 return 0;
3894 }
3895
3896
3897 #if defined USE_LUCID
3898
3899 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3900 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3901
3902 static Widget
3903 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3904 Window window;
3905 {
3906 Lisp_Object tail;
3907
3908 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3909 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3910 tail = XCDR (tail))
3911 {
3912 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3913 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3914
3915 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3916 return menu_bar;
3917 }
3918
3919 return NULL;
3920 }
3921
3922 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3923
3924 \f
3925 /************************************************************************
3926 Toolkit scroll bars
3927 ************************************************************************/
3928
3929 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3930
3931 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3932 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3933 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3934 struct scroll_bar *));
3935 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3936 int, int, int));
3937
3938
3939 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3940 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3941
3942 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3943
3944 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3945
3946 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3947
3948 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3949 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3950
3951 #ifndef USE_GTK
3952 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3953
3954 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3955
3956 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3957
3958 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3959 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3960 to avoid jerkyness. */
3961
3962 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3963
3964 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3965 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3966 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3967 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3968
3969 static void
3970 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3971 num_params)
3972 Widget widget;
3973 XtPointer client_data;
3974 String action_name;
3975 XEvent *event;
3976 String *params;
3977 Cardinal *num_params;
3978 {
3979 int scroll_bar_p;
3980 char *end_action;
3981
3982 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3983 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3984 end_action = "Release";
3985 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3986 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3987 end_action = "EndScroll";
3988 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3989
3990 if (scroll_bar_p
3991 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3992 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3993 {
3994 struct window *w;
3995
3996 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3997 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3998 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
3999
4000 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4001 {
4002 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4003 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4004 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4005 }
4006 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4007 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4008
4009 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4010 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4011 }
4012 }
4013 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4014
4015 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4016 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4017
4018 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4019 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4020
4021
4022 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4023 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4024 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4025 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4026
4027 static void
4028 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4029 Lisp_Object window;
4030 int part, portion, whole;
4031 {
4032 XEvent event;
4033 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4034 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4035 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4036 int i;
4037
4038 BLOCK_INPUT;
4039
4040 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4041 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4042 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4043 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4044 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4045 ev->format = 32;
4046
4047 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4048 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4049 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4050 into that array in the event. */
4051 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4052 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4053 break;
4054
4055 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4056 {
4057 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4058 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4059 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4060
4061 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4062 nbytes);
4063 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4064 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4065 }
4066
4067 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4068 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4069 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4070 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4071 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4072 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4073
4074 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4075 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4076
4077 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4078 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4079 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4080 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4081 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4082 }
4083
4084
4085 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4086 in *IEVENT. */
4087
4088 static void
4089 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4090 XEvent *event;
4091 struct input_event *ievent;
4092 {
4093 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4094 Lisp_Object window;
4095 struct frame *f;
4096 struct window *w;
4097
4098 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4099 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4100
4101 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4102 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4103
4104 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4105 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4106 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4107 #ifdef USE_GTK
4108 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4109 #else
4110 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4111 #endif
4112 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4113 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4114 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4115 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4116 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4117 }
4118
4119
4120 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4121
4122 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4123
4124 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4125
4126
4127 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4128 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4129 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4130
4131 static void
4132 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4133 Widget widget;
4134 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4135 {
4136 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4137 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4138 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4139
4140 switch (cs->reason)
4141 {
4142 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4143 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4144 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4145 break;
4146
4147 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4148 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4149 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4150 break;
4151
4152 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4153 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4154 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4155 break;
4156
4157 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4158 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4159 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4160 break;
4161
4162 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4163 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4164 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4165 break;
4166
4167 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4168 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4169 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4170 break;
4171
4172 case XmCR_DRAG:
4173 {
4174 int slider_size;
4175
4176 /* Get the slider size. */
4177 BLOCK_INPUT;
4178 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4179 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4180
4181 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4182 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4183 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4184 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4185 }
4186 break;
4187
4188 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4189 break;
4190 };
4191
4192 if (part >= 0)
4193 {
4194 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4195 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4196 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4197 }
4198 }
4199
4200
4201 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4202 #ifdef USE_GTK
4203 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4204 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4205
4206 static void
4207 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4208 GtkRange *widget;
4209 gpointer data;
4210 {
4211 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4212 gdouble previous;
4213 gdouble position;
4214 gdouble *p;
4215 int diff;
4216
4217 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4218 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4219
4220 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4221
4222 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4223 if (! p)
4224 {
4225 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4226 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4227 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4228 }
4229
4230 previous = *p;
4231 *p = position;
4232
4233 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4234
4235 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4236
4237 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4238 {
4239 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4240 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4241 }
4242 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4243 {
4244 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4245 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4246 }
4247 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4248 {
4249 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4251 }
4252 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4253 {
4254 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4255 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4256 }
4257 else
4258 {
4259 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4260 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4261 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4262 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4263 }
4264
4265 if (part >= 0)
4266 {
4267 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4268 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4269 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4270 }
4271 }
4272
4273 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4274
4275 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4276 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4277 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4278 the thumb is. */
4279
4280 static void
4281 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4282 Widget widget;
4283 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4284 {
4285 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4286 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4287 float shown;
4288 int whole, portion, height;
4289 int part;
4290
4291 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4292 BLOCK_INPUT;
4293 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4294 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4295
4296 whole = 10000000;
4297 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4298
4299 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4300 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4301 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4302 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4303 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4304 bottom). */
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 else
4307 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4308
4309 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4310 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4311 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4312 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4313 }
4314
4315
4316 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4317 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4318 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4319 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4320 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4321 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4322 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4323
4324 static void
4325 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4326 Widget widget;
4327 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4328 {
4329 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4330 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4331 int position = (long) call_data;
4332 Dimension height;
4333 int part;
4334
4335 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4336 BLOCK_INPUT;
4337 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4338 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4339
4340 if (abs (position) >= height)
4341 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4342
4343 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4344 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4345 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4346 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4347 else
4348 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4349
4350 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4351 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4352 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4353 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4354 }
4355
4356 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4357 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4358
4359 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4360
4361 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4362 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4363
4364 #ifdef USE_GTK
4365 static void
4366 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4367 struct frame *f;
4368 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4369 {
4370 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4371
4372 BLOCK_INPUT;
4373 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4374 scroll_bar_name);
4375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4376 }
4377
4378 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4379
4380 static void
4381 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4382 struct frame *f;
4383 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4384 {
4385 Window xwindow;
4386 Widget widget;
4387 Arg av[20];
4388 int ac = 0;
4389 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4390 unsigned long pixel;
4391
4392 BLOCK_INPUT;
4393
4394 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4395 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4396 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4397 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4398 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4400 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4402 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4403
4404 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4405 if (pixel != -1)
4406 {
4407 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4408 ++ac;
4409 }
4410
4411 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4412 if (pixel != -1)
4413 {
4414 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4415 ++ac;
4416 }
4417
4418 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4419 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4420
4421 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4422 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4423 (XtPointer) bar);
4424 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4425 (XtPointer) bar);
4426 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4427 (XtPointer) bar);
4428 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4429 (XtPointer) bar);
4430 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4431 (XtPointer) bar);
4432 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4433 (XtPointer) bar);
4434 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4435 (XtPointer) bar);
4436
4437 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4438 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4439
4440 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4441 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4442 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4443 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4444
4445 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4446
4447 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4448 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4449 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4450 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4451 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4452 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4453 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4454 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4455
4456 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4457 if (pixel != -1)
4458 {
4459 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4460 ++ac;
4461 }
4462
4463 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4464 if (pixel != -1)
4465 {
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4467 ++ac;
4468 }
4469
4470 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4471
4472 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4473 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4474 {
4475 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4476 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4477 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4478 pixel = -1;
4479 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4480 }
4481 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4482 {
4483 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4484 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4485 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4486 pixel = -1;
4487 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4488 }
4489
4490 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4491 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4492 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4493 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4494 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4495 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4496 {
4497 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4498 ++ac;
4499 }
4500 else
4501 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4502 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4503 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4504 {
4505 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4506 the shadows. */
4507 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4508 ++ac;
4509
4510 /* Specify the colors. */
4511 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4512 if (pixel != -1)
4513 {
4514 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4515 ++ac;
4516 }
4517 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4518 if (pixel != -1)
4519 {
4520 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4521 ++ac;
4522 }
4523 }
4524 #endif
4525
4526 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4527 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4528
4529 {
4530 char *initial = "";
4531 char *val = initial;
4532 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4533 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4534 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4535 #endif
4536 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4537 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4538 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4539 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4540 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4541 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4542 }
4543 }
4544
4545 /* Define callbacks. */
4546 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4547 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4548 (XtPointer) bar);
4549
4550 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4551 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4552
4553 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4554
4555 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4556 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4557 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4558 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4559
4560 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4561 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4562 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4563 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4564
4565 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4566 }
4567 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4568
4569
4570 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4571 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4572
4573 #ifdef USE_GTK
4574 static void
4575 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4576 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4577 int portion, position, whole;
4578 {
4579 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4580 }
4581
4582 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4583 static void
4584 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4585 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4586 int portion, position, whole;
4587 {
4588 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4589 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4590 float top, shown;
4591
4592 BLOCK_INPUT;
4593
4594 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4595
4596 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4597 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4598 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4599 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4600 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4601 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4602 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4603 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4604 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4605 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4606 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4607 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4608 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4609 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4610 whole += portion;
4611
4612 if (whole <= 0)
4613 top = 0, shown = 1;
4614 else
4615 {
4616 top = (float) position / whole;
4617 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4618 }
4619
4620 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4621 {
4622 int size, value;
4623
4624 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4625 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4626 value. */
4627 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4628 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4629 size = max (size, 1);
4630
4631 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4632 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4633 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4634
4635 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4636 }
4637 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4638
4639 if (whole == 0)
4640 top = 0, shown = 1;
4641 else
4642 {
4643 top = (float) position / whole;
4644 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4645 }
4646
4647 {
4648 float old_top, old_shown;
4649 Dimension height;
4650 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4651 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4652 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4653 XtNheight, &height,
4654 NULL);
4655
4656 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4657 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4658 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4659 else
4660 top = old_top;
4661 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4662 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4663
4664 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4665 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4666 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4667 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4668 {
4669 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4670 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4671 else
4672 {
4673 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4674 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4675 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4676
4677 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4678 }
4679 }
4680 }
4681 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4682
4683 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4684 }
4685 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4686
4687 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4688
4689
4690 \f
4691 /************************************************************************
4692 Scroll bars, general
4693 ************************************************************************/
4694
4695 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4696 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4697 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4698 scroll bar. */
4699
4700 static struct scroll_bar *
4701 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4702 struct window *w;
4703 int top, left, width, height;
4704 {
4705 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4706 struct scroll_bar *bar
4707 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4708
4709 BLOCK_INPUT;
4710
4711 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4712 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4713 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4714 {
4715 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4716 unsigned long mask;
4717 Window window;
4718
4719 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4720 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4721 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4722
4723 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4724 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4725 | ExposureMask);
4726 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4727
4728 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4729
4730 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4731 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4732 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4733 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4734 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4735 left, top, width,
4736 window_box_height (w), False);
4737
4738 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4739 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4740 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4741 top,
4742 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4743 height,
4744 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4745 0,
4746 CopyFromParent,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 /* Attributes. */
4750 mask, &a);
4751 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4752 }
4753 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4754
4755 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4756 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4757 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4758 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4759 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4760 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4761 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4762 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4763
4764 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4765 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4766 bar->prev = Qnil;
4767 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4768 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4769 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4770
4771 /* Map the window/widget. */
4772 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4773 {
4774 #ifdef USE_GTK
4775 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4776 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4777 top,
4778 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4779 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4780 max (height, 1));
4781 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4782 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4783 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4784 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4785 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4786 top,
4787 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4788 max (height, 1), 0);
4789 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4790 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4791 }
4792 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4793 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4794 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4795
4796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4797 return bar;
4798 }
4799
4800
4801 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4802
4803 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4804 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4805 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4806 events.)
4807
4808 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4809 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4810 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4811 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4812 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4813
4814 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4815
4816 static void
4817 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4818 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4819 int start, end;
4820 int rebuild;
4821 {
4822 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4823 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4824 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4825 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4826
4827 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4828 if (! rebuild
4829 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4830 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4831 return;
4832
4833 BLOCK_INPUT;
4834
4835 {
4836 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4837 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4838 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4839
4840 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4841 the distance between start and end. */
4842 {
4843 int length = end - start;
4844
4845 if (start < 0)
4846 start = 0;
4847 else if (start > top_range)
4848 start = top_range;
4849 end = start + length;
4850
4851 if (end < start)
4852 end = start;
4853 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4854 end = top_range;
4855 }
4856
4857 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4858 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4859 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4860
4861 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4862 if (end > top_range)
4863 end = top_range;
4864
4865 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4866 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4867 that many pixels tall. */
4868 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4869
4870 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4871 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4872 if (0 < start)
4873 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4874 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4875 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4876 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4877 inside_width, start,
4878 False);
4879
4880 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4881 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4882 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4883 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4884
4885 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4886 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4887 /* x, y, width, height */
4888 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4889 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4890 inside_width, end - start);
4891
4892 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4893 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4894 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4895 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4896
4897 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4898 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4899 if (end < inside_height)
4900 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4901 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4902 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4904 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4905 False);
4906
4907 }
4908
4909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4910 }
4911
4912 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4913
4914 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4915 nil. */
4916
4917 static void
4918 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4919 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4920 {
4921 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4922 BLOCK_INPUT;
4923
4924 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4925 #ifdef USE_GTK
4926 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4927 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4928 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4929 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4930 #else
4931 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4932 #endif
4933
4934 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4935 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4936
4937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4938 }
4939
4940
4941 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4942 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4943 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4944 create one. */
4945
4946 static void
4947 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4948 struct window *w;
4949 int portion, whole, position;
4950 {
4951 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4952 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4953 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4954 int window_y, window_height;
4955
4956 /* Get window dimensions. */
4957 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4958 top = window_y;
4959 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4960 height = window_height;
4961
4962 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4963 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4964
4965 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4966 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4967 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4968 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4969 else
4970 sb_width = width;
4971
4972 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4973 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4974 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4975 sb_left = (left +
4976 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4977 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4978 : 0));
4979 else
4980 sb_left = (left +
4981 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
4982 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
4983 : width - sb_width));
4984 #else
4985 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4986 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4987 else
4988 sb_left = left;
4989 #endif
4990
4991 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4992 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4993 {
4994 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4995 {
4996 BLOCK_INPUT;
4997 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4998 left, top, width, height, False);
4999 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5000 }
5001
5002 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5003 }
5004 else
5005 {
5006 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5007 unsigned int mask = 0;
5008
5009 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5010
5011 BLOCK_INPUT;
5012
5013 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5014 mask |= CWX;
5015 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5016 mask |= CWY;
5017 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5018 mask |= CWWidth;
5019 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5020 mask |= CWHeight;
5021
5022 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5023
5024 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5025 if (mask)
5026 {
5027 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5028 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5029 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5030 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5031 left, top, width, height, False);
5032 #ifdef USE_GTK
5033 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5034 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5035 top,
5036 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5037 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5038 max (height, 1));
5039 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5040 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5041 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5042 top,
5043 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5044 max (height, 1), 0);
5045 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5046 }
5047 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5048
5049 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5050 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5051 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5052 {
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5054 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5055 height, False);
5056 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5057 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5058 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 height, False);
5060 }
5061
5062 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5063 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5064 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5065 example. */
5066 {
5067 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5068 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5069 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5070 {
5071 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5072 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5073 left + area_width - rest, top,
5074 rest, height, False);
5075 else
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5077 left, top, rest, height, False);
5078 }
5079 }
5080
5081 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5082 if (mask)
5083 {
5084 XWindowChanges wc;
5085
5086 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5087 wc.y = top;
5088 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5089 wc.height = height;
5090 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5091 mask, &wc);
5092 }
5093
5094 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5095
5096 /* Remember new settings. */
5097 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5098 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5099 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5100 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5101
5102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5103 }
5104
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5107 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5108 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5109 dragged. */
5110 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5111 {
5112 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5113
5114 if (whole == 0)
5115 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5116 else
5117 {
5118 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5119 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5120 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5121 }
5122 }
5123 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5124
5125 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5126 }
5127
5128
5129 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5130 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5131 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5132 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5133 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5134 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5135 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5136
5137 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5138 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5139 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5140
5141 static void
5142 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5143 FRAME_PTR frame;
5144 {
5145 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5146 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5147 {
5148 Lisp_Object bar;
5149 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5150 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5151 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5153 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5154 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5155 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5156 }
5157 }
5158
5159
5160 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5161 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5162
5163 static void
5164 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5165 struct window *window;
5166 {
5167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5168 struct frame *f;
5169
5170 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5171 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5172 abort ();
5173
5174 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5175
5176 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5177 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5178 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5179 {
5180 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5181 the lists. */
5182 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5183 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5184 return;
5185 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5186 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5187 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5188 else
5189 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5190 one or the other! */
5191 abort ();
5192 }
5193 else
5194 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5195
5196 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5197 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5198
5199 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5200 bar->prev = Qnil;
5201 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5202 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5203 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5204 }
5205
5206 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5207 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5208
5209 static void
5210 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5211 FRAME_PTR f;
5212 {
5213 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5214
5215 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5216
5217 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5218 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5219 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5220
5221 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5222 {
5223 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5224
5225 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5226
5227 next = b->next;
5228 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5232 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5233 }
5234
5235
5236 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5237 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5238 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5239
5240 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5241 mark bits. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5245 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5246 XEvent *event;
5247 {
5248 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5249 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5250 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5251 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5252
5253 BLOCK_INPUT;
5254
5255 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5256
5257 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5258 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5259
5260 /* x, y, width, height */
5261 0, 0,
5262 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5263 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5264
5265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5266
5267 }
5268 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5269
5270 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5271 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5272
5273 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5274 mark bits. */
5275
5276
5277 static void
5278 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5279 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5280 XEvent *event;
5281 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5282 {
5283 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5284 abort ();
5285
5286 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5287 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5288 emacs_event->modifiers
5289 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5290 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5291 event->xbutton.state)
5292 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5293 ? up_modifier
5294 : down_modifier));
5295 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5296 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5297 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5298 {
5299 #if 0
5300 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5301 int internal_height
5302 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5303 #endif
5304 int top_range
5305 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5306 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5307
5308 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5309 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5310
5311 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5312 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5313 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5314 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5315 else
5316 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5317
5318 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5319 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5320 whether or not we're dragging. */
5321 #if 0
5322 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5323 holding it. */
5324 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5325 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5326 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5327 #endif
5328
5329 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5330 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5331 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5332 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5333 {
5334 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5335 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5336
5337 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5339 }
5340 #endif
5341
5342 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5343 #if 0
5344 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5345 the handle. */
5346 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5347 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5348 else
5349 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5350 #else
5351 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5352 #endif
5353
5354 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5355 }
5356 }
5357
5358 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5359
5360 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5361
5362 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5363 mark bits. */
5364
5365 static void
5366 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5367 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5368 XEvent *event;
5369 {
5370 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5371
5372 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5373
5374 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5375 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5376
5377 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5378 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5379 {
5380 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5381 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5382
5383 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5384 {
5385 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5386
5387 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5388 }
5389 }
5390 }
5391
5392 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5393
5394 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5395 on the scroll bar. */
5396
5397 static void
5398 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5399 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5400 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5401 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5402 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5403 unsigned long *time;
5404 {
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5406 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5408 int win_x, win_y;
5409 Window dummy_window;
5410 int dummy_coord;
5411 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5412
5413 BLOCK_INPUT;
5414
5415 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5416 report that. */
5417 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5418
5419 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5420 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5421 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5422
5423 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5424 &win_x, &win_y,
5425
5426 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5427 &dummy_mask))
5428 ;
5429 else
5430 {
5431 #if 0
5432 int inside_height
5433 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5434 #endif
5435 int top_range
5436 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5437
5438 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5439
5440 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5441 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5442
5443 if (win_y < 0)
5444 win_y = 0;
5445 if (win_y > top_range)
5446 win_y = top_range;
5447
5448 *fp = f;
5449 *bar_window = bar->window;
5450
5451 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5452 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5453 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5454 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5455 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5456 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5457 else
5458 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5459
5460 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5461 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5462
5463 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5464 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5465 }
5466
5467 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5468
5469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5470 }
5471
5472
5473 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5474 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5475 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5476 redraw them. */
5477
5478 void
5479 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5480 FRAME_PTR f;
5481 {
5482 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5483 Lisp_Object bar;
5484
5485 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5486 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5487 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5488 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5489 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5490 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5491 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5492 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5493 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5495 }
5496
5497 \f
5498 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5499
5500 #if 0
5501 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5502 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5503 sometimes don't work. */
5504
5505 static Time enter_timestamp;
5506 #endif
5507
5508 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5509 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5510 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5511 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5512
5513 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5514 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5515
5516 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5517
5518 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5519 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5520
5521 static int temp_index;
5522 static short temp_buffer[100];
5523
5524 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5525 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5526 temp_index = 0; \
5527 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5528
5529 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5530 on a particular display. */
5531
5532 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5533
5534 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5535 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5536 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5537 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5538
5539 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5540
5541 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5542 do \
5543 { \
5544 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5545 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5546 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5547 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5548 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5549 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5550 } \
5551 while (0)
5552
5553 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5554 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5555
5556
5557 enum
5558 {
5559 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5560 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5561 X_EVENT_DROP
5562 };
5563
5564 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5565 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5566 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5567
5568 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5569 this event further.
5570 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5571
5572 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5573 static int
5574 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5575 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5576 XEvent *event;
5577 {
5578 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5579 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5580 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5581 was created. */
5582
5583 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5584 event->xclient.window);
5585
5586 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5587 }
5588 #endif
5589
5590 #ifdef USE_GTK
5591 static int current_count;
5592 static int current_finish;
5593 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5594
5595 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5596 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5597 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5598 static GdkFilterReturn
5599 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5600 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5601 GdkEvent *ev;
5602 gpointer data;
5603 {
5604 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5605
5606 if (current_count >= 0)
5607 {
5608 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5609
5610 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5611
5612 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5613 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5614 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5615 so we do it here. */
5616 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5617 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5618 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5619 #endif
5620
5621 if (! dpyinfo)
5622 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5623 else
5624 {
5625 current_count +=
5626 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5627 current_hold_quit);
5628 }
5629 }
5630 else
5631 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5632
5633 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5634 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5635
5636 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5637 }
5638 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5639
5640
5641 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5642
5643 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5644 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5645 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5646
5647 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5648
5649 static int
5650 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5651 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5652 XEvent *eventp;
5653 int *finish;
5654 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5655 {
5656 union {
5657 struct input_event ie;
5658 struct selection_input_event sie;
5659 } inev;
5660 int count = 0;
5661 int do_help = 0;
5662 int nbytes = 0;
5663 struct frame *f;
5664 struct coding_system coding;
5665 XEvent event = *eventp;
5666
5667 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5668
5669 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5670 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5671 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5672
5673 switch (event.type)
5674 {
5675 case ClientMessage:
5676 {
5677 if (event.xclient.message_type
5678 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5679 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5680 {
5681 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5682 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5683 {
5684 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5685 could be the shell widget window
5686 if the frame has no title bar. */
5687 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5688 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5689 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5690 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5691 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5692 #endif
5693 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5694 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5695 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5696 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5697 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5698 needed.
5699
5700 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5701 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5702 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5703 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5704 Emacs. */
5705
5706 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5707 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5708 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5709 if (f)
5710 {
5711 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5712 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5713 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5714 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5715 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5716 /* The ICCCM says this is
5717 the only valid choice. */
5718 RevertToParent,
5719 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5720 /* This is needed to detect the error
5721 if there is an error. */
5722 XSync (d, False);
5723 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5724 }
5725 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5726 #endif /* 0 */
5727 goto done;
5728 }
5729
5730 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5731 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5732 {
5733 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5734 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5735 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5736 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5737 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5738 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5739 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5740 session manager and one for this. */
5741 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5742 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5743 #endif
5744 {
5745 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5746 event.xclient.window);
5747 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5748 for a single Emacs process. */
5749 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5750 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5751 event.xclient.window,
5752 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5753 else if (f)
5754 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5755 event.xclient.window,
5756 0, 0);
5757 }
5758 goto done;
5759 }
5760
5761 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5762 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5763 {
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5765 event.xclient.window);
5766 if (!f)
5767 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5768
5769 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5771 goto done;
5772 }
5773
5774 goto done;
5775 }
5776
5777 if (event.xclient.message_type
5778 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5779 {
5780 goto done;
5781 }
5782
5783 if (event.xclient.message_type
5784 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5785 {
5786 int new_x, new_y;
5787 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5788
5789 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5790 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5791
5792 if (f)
5793 {
5794 f->left_pos = new_x;
5795 f->top_pos = new_y;
5796 }
5797 goto done;
5798 }
5799
5800 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5801 if (event.xclient.message_type
5802 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5803 {
5804 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5805 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5806 &event, NULL);
5807 goto done;
5808 }
5809 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5810
5811 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5812 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5813 || (event.xclient.message_type
5814 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5815 {
5816 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5817 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5818 currently never do because we are interested in
5819 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5820 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5821 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5822 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5823 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5824 goto done;
5825 }
5826
5827 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5828 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5829 we construct an input_event. */
5830 if (event.xclient.message_type
5831 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5832 {
5833 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5834 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5835 goto done;
5836 }
5837 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5838
5839 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5840
5841 if (!f)
5842 goto OTHER;
5843
5844 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5845 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5846 }
5847 break;
5848
5849 case SelectionNotify:
5850 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5851 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5852 goto OTHER;
5853 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5854 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5855 break;
5856
5857 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5858 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5859 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5860 goto OTHER;
5861 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5862 {
5863 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5864
5865 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5866 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5867 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5868 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5869 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5870 }
5871 break;
5872
5873 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5874 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5875 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5876 goto OTHER;
5877 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5878 {
5879 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5880 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5881
5882 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5883 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5886 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5887 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5889 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5890 }
5891 break;
5892
5893 case PropertyNotify:
5894 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5895 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5896 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5897 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5898 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5899 goto OTHER;
5900 #endif
5901 #endif
5902 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5903 goto OTHER;
5904
5905 case ReparentNotify:
5906 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5907 if (f)
5908 {
5909 int x, y;
5910 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5911 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5912 f->left_pos = x;
5913 f->top_pos = y;
5914
5915 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5916 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5917 }
5918 goto OTHER;
5919
5920 case Expose:
5921 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5922 if (f)
5923 {
5924 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5925
5926 #ifdef USE_GTK
5927 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5928 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5929 event.xexpose.window,
5930 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5931 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5932 FALSE);
5933 #endif
5934 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5935 {
5936 f->async_visible = 1;
5937 f->async_iconified = 0;
5938 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5939 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5940 }
5941 else
5942 expose_frame (f,
5943 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5944 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5945 }
5946 else
5947 {
5948 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5949 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5950 #endif
5951 #if defined USE_LUCID
5952 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5953 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5954 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5955 {
5956 Widget widget
5957 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5958 if (widget)
5959 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5960 }
5961 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5962
5963 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5964 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5965 goto OTHER;
5966 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5967 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5968 event.xexpose.window);
5969
5970 if (bar)
5971 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5972 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5973 else
5974 goto OTHER;
5975 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5976 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5977 }
5978 break;
5979
5980 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5981 source area was obscured or not
5982 available. */
5983 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5984 if (f)
5985 {
5986 expose_frame (f,
5987 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
5988 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
5989 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
5990 }
5991 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5992 else
5993 goto OTHER;
5994 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5995 break;
5996
5997 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5998 source area was completely
5999 available. */
6000 break;
6001
6002 case UnmapNotify:
6003 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6004 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6005 {
6006 tip_window = 0;
6007 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6008 }
6009
6010 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6011 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6012 the frame was deleted. */
6013 {
6014 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6015 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6016 display that won't ever be seen. */
6017 f->async_visible = 0;
6018 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6019 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6020 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6021 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6022 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6023 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6024 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6025 {
6026 f->async_iconified = 1;
6027
6028 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6029 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6030 }
6031 }
6032 goto OTHER;
6033
6034 case MapNotify:
6035 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6036 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6037 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6038 goto OTHER;
6039
6040 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6041 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6042 frame is visible. */
6043 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6044 if (f)
6045 {
6046 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6047 the frame's display structures.
6048 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6049 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6050 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6051 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6052 if (! f->async_iconified)
6053 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6054
6055 f->async_visible = 1;
6056 f->async_iconified = 0;
6057 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6058
6059 if (f->iconified)
6060 {
6061 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6062 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6063 }
6064 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6065 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6066 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6067 to update the frame titles
6068 in case this is the second frame. */
6069 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6070 }
6071 goto OTHER;
6072
6073 case KeyPress:
6074
6075 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6076
6077 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6078 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6079 if (popup_activated ())
6080 goto OTHER;
6081 #endif
6082
6083 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6084
6085 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6086 {
6087 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6088 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6089 }
6090
6091 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6092 if (f == 0)
6093 {
6094 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6095 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6096 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6097 event.xkey.window);
6098 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6099 {
6100 widget = XtParent (widget);
6101 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6102 }
6103 }
6104 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6105
6106 if (f != 0)
6107 {
6108 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6109 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6110 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6111 his Emacs hang.
6112
6113 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6114 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6115 status_return even if the input is too long to
6116 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6117 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6118 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6119 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6120 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6121 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6122 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6123 int modifiers;
6124 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6125 Lisp_Object c;
6126
6127 #ifdef USE_GTK
6128 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6129 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6130 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6131 (see above). */
6132 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6133 #endif
6134
6135 event.xkey.state
6136 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6137 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6138 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6139
6140 /* This will have to go some day... */
6141
6142 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6143 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6144 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6145 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6146 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6147 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6148 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6149
6150 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6151 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6152 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6153 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6154 not it is combined with Meta. */
6155 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6156 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6157
6158 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6159 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6160 {
6161 Status status_return;
6162
6163 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6164 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6165 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6166 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6167 &status_return);
6168 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6169 {
6170 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6171 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6172 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6173 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6174 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6175 &status_return);
6176 }
6177 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6178 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6179 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6180 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6181 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6182 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6183 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6184 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6185 &status_return);
6186 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6187 {
6188 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6189 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6190 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6191 &event.xkey,
6192 copy_bufptr,
6193 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6194 &status_return);
6195 }
6196 }
6197 #endif
6198
6199 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6200 break;
6201 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6202 {
6203 keysym = NoSymbol;
6204 modifiers = 0;
6205 }
6206 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6207 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6208 abort ();
6209 }
6210 else
6211 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6212 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6213 &compose_status);
6214 #else
6215 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6216 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6217 &compose_status);
6218 #endif
6219
6220 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6221 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6222 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6223 break;
6224
6225 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6226 orig_keysym = keysym;
6227
6228 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6229 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6230 inev.ie.modifiers
6231 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6232 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6233
6234 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6235 translations to characters. */
6236 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6237 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6238 {
6239 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6240 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6241 goto done_keysym;
6242 }
6243
6244 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6245 if ((keysym >= 0x01000100 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6246 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6247 {
6248 int code, charset_id, c1, c2;
6249
6250 if (keysym < 0x01002500)
6251 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6252 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0x100;
6253 else if (keysym < 0x0100e000)
6254 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6255 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0x2500;
6256 else
6257 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6258 code = (keysym & 0xFFFF) - 0xe000;
6259 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6260 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6261 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6262 goto done_keysym;
6263 }
6264
6265 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6266 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6267 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6268 Vx_keysym_table,
6269 Qnil))))
6270 {
6271 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6272 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6273 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6274 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6275 goto done_keysym;
6276 }
6277
6278 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6279 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6280 || keysym == XK_Delete
6281 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6282 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6283 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6284 #endif
6285 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6286 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6287 #ifdef HPUX
6288 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6289 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6290 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6291 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6292 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6293 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6294 #endif
6295 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6296 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6297 #endif
6298 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6299 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6300 #endif
6301 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6302 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6303 #endif
6304 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6305 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6306 #endif
6307 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6308 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6309 #endif
6310 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6311 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6312 #endif
6313 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6314 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6315 #endif
6316 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6317 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6318 #endif
6319 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6320 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6321 #endif
6322 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6323 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6324 #endif
6325 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6326 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6327 #endif
6328 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6329 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6330 #endif
6331 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6332 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6333 #endif
6334 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6335 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6336 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6337 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6338 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6339 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6340 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6341 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6342 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6343 #endif
6344 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6345 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6346 #endif
6347 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6348 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6349 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6350 don't have real modifiers but
6351 should be treated similarly to
6352 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6353 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6354 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6355 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6356 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6357 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6358 #endif
6359 ))
6360 {
6361 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6362 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6363 key. */
6364 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6365 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6366 goto done_keysym;
6367 }
6368
6369 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6370 register int i;
6371 register int c;
6372 int nchars, len;
6373
6374 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6375 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6376 we used just above and the locale. */
6377 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6378 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6379 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6380 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6381 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6382 gives us composition information. */
6383 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6384
6385 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6386 {
6387 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6388 }
6389
6390 {
6391 /* Decode the input data. */
6392 int require;
6393 unsigned char *p;
6394
6395 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6396 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6397 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6398 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6399 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6400 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6401 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6402 nbytes = coding.produced;
6403 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6404 copy_bufptr = p;
6405 }
6406
6407 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6408 character events. */
6409 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6410 {
6411 if (nchars == nbytes)
6412 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6413 else
6414 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6415 nbytes - i, len);
6416 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6417 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6418 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6419 inev.ie.code = c;
6420 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6421 }
6422
6423 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6424 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6425 count += nbytes;
6426
6427 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6428
6429 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6430 break;
6431 }
6432 }
6433 done_keysym:
6434 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6435 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6436 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6437 client. */
6438 break;
6439 #else
6440 goto OTHER;
6441 #endif
6442
6443 case KeyRelease:
6444 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6445 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6446 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6447 client. */
6448 break;
6449 #else
6450 goto OTHER;
6451 #endif
6452
6453 case EnterNotify:
6454 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6455
6456 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6457
6458 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6459 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6460
6461 #if 0
6462 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6463 {
6464 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6465 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6466 || !(f->auto_lower)
6467 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6468 {
6469 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6470 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6471 }
6472 }
6473 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6474 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6475 #endif
6476
6477 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6478 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6479 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6480 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6481 goto OTHER;
6482
6483 case FocusIn:
6484 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6485 goto OTHER;
6486
6487 case LeaveNotify:
6488 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6489
6490 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6491 if (f)
6492 {
6493 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6494 {
6495 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6496 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6497 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6498 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6499 }
6500
6501 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6502 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6503 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6504 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6505 if (any_help_event_p)
6506 do_help = -1;
6507 }
6508 goto OTHER;
6509
6510 case FocusOut:
6511 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6512 goto OTHER;
6513
6514 case MotionNotify:
6515 {
6516 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6517 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6518
6519 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6520 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6521 f = last_mouse_frame;
6522 else
6523 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6524
6525 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6526 {
6527 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6528 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6529 }
6530
6531 if (f)
6532 {
6533
6534 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6535 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6536 {
6537 Lisp_Object window;
6538
6539 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6540 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6541 0, 0, 0, 0);
6542
6543 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6544 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6545 will be selected iff it is active. */
6546 if (WINDOWP (window)
6547 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6548 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6549 {
6550 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6551 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6552 }
6553
6554 last_window=window;
6555 }
6556 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6557 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6558 }
6559 else
6560 {
6561 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6562 struct scroll_bar *bar
6563 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6564 event.xmotion.window);
6565
6566 if (bar)
6567 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6568 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6569
6570 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6571 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6572 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6573 }
6574
6575 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6576 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6577 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6578 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6579 do_help = 1;
6580 goto OTHER;
6581 }
6582
6583 case ConfigureNotify:
6584 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6585 if (f)
6586 {
6587 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6588 #ifdef USE_GTK
6589 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6590 event.xconfigure.height);
6591 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6592 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6593 do this one, the right one will come later.
6594 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6595 need to reset it below. */
6596 int dont_resize
6597 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6598 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6599 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6600 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6601
6602 if (dont_resize)
6603 goto OTHER;
6604
6605 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6606 is called by the code that handles resizing
6607 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6608
6609 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6610 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6611 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6612 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6613 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6614 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6615 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6616 {
6617 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6618 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6619 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6620 }
6621 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6622 #endif
6623
6624 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6625 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6626
6627 #ifdef USE_GTK
6628 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6629 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6630 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6631 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6632 #endif
6633 {
6634 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6635 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6636 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6637
6638 x_check_expected_move (f);
6639 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6640 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6641 }
6642
6643 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6644 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6645 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6646 #endif
6647
6648 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6649 {
6650 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6651 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6652 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6653 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6654 }
6655 }
6656 goto OTHER;
6657
6658 case ButtonRelease:
6659 case ButtonPress:
6660 {
6661 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6662 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6663 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6664
6665 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6666 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6667
6668 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6669 && last_mouse_frame
6670 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6671 f = last_mouse_frame;
6672 else
6673 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6674
6675 if (f)
6676 {
6677 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6678 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6679 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6680 {
6681 Lisp_Object window;
6682 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6683 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6684
6685 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6686 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6687 {
6688 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6689 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6690 else
6691 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6692 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6693 event.xbutton.state));
6694 tool_bar_p = 1;
6695 }
6696 }
6697
6698 if (!tool_bar_p)
6699 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6700 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6701 {
6702 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6703 if (! popup_activated ())
6704 #endif
6705 {
6706 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6707 {
6708 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6709 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6710 {
6711 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6712 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6713 }
6714 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6715 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6716 }
6717 else
6718 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6719 }
6720 }
6721 }
6722 else
6723 {
6724 struct scroll_bar *bar
6725 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6726 event.xbutton.window);
6727
6728 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6729 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6730 scroll bars. */
6731 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6732 {
6733 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6734 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6735 }
6736 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6737 if (bar)
6738 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6739 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6740 }
6741
6742 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6743 {
6744 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6745 last_mouse_frame = f;
6746
6747 if (!tool_bar_p)
6748 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6749 }
6750 else
6751 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6752
6753 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6754 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6755 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6756 if (f != 0)
6757 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6758
6759 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6760 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6761 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6762 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6763 Instead, save it away
6764 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6765 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6766 if (
6767 #ifdef USE_GTK
6768 ! popup_activated ()
6769 &&
6770 #endif
6771 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6772 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6773 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6774 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6775 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6776 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6777 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6778 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6779 {
6780 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6781 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6782 #ifdef USE_GTK
6783 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6784 #endif
6785 }
6786 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6787 {
6788 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6789 goto OTHER;
6790 }
6791
6792 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6793 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6794 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6795 {
6796 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6797 {
6798 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6799 if (f->output_data.x)
6800 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6801 }
6802 else
6803 goto OTHER;
6804 }
6805 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6806 else
6807 goto OTHER;
6808 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6809 }
6810 break;
6811
6812 case CirculateNotify:
6813 goto OTHER;
6814
6815 case CirculateRequest:
6816 goto OTHER;
6817
6818 case VisibilityNotify:
6819 goto OTHER;
6820
6821 case MappingNotify:
6822 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6823 local cache. */
6824 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6825 {
6826 case MappingModifier:
6827 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6828 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6829 case MappingKeyboard:
6830 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6831 }
6832 goto OTHER;
6833
6834 default:
6835 OTHER:
6836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6837 BLOCK_INPUT;
6838 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6839 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6841 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6842 break;
6843 }
6844
6845 done:
6846 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6847 {
6848 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6849 count++;
6850 }
6851
6852 if (do_help
6853 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6854 {
6855 Lisp_Object frame;
6856
6857 if (f)
6858 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6859 else
6860 frame = Qnil;
6861
6862 if (do_help > 0)
6863 {
6864 any_help_event_p = 1;
6865 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6866 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6867 }
6868 else
6869 {
6870 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6871 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6872 }
6873 count++;
6874 }
6875
6876 *eventp = event;
6877 return count;
6878 }
6879
6880
6881 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6882 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6883 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6884
6885 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6886 int
6887 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6888 XEvent *event;
6889 Display *display;
6890 {
6891 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6892 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6893
6894 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6895
6896 if (dpyinfo)
6897 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6898
6899 return finish;
6900 }
6901
6902
6903 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6904 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6905 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6906
6907 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6908 thus pretending to be `read'.
6909
6910 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6911
6912 static int
6913 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6914 register int sd;
6915 int expected;
6916 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6917 {
6918 int count = 0;
6919 XEvent event;
6920 int event_found = 0;
6921 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6922
6923 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6924 {
6925 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6926 return -1;
6927 }
6928
6929 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6930 BLOCK_INPUT;
6931
6932 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6933 input_signal_count++;
6934
6935 ++handling_signal;
6936
6937 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6938 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6939 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6940 {
6941 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6942 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6943 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6944 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6945 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6946 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6947 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6948 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6949 #endif
6950
6951 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6952 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6953 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6954 for X connections. */
6955 #ifndef SIGIO
6956 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
6957 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
6958 {
6959 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
6960 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
6961 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6962 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
6963 }
6964 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
6965 #endif /* SIGIO */
6966 #endif
6967
6968 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6969 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6970 {
6971 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
6972 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
6973 }
6974
6975 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6976 {
6977 struct input_event inev;
6978 BLOCK_INPUT;
6979 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
6980 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
6981 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
6982 {
6983 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6984 count++;
6985 }
6986 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6987 }
6988 #endif
6989
6990 #ifndef USE_GTK
6991 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
6992 {
6993 int finish;
6994
6995 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6996
6997 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6998 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
6999 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7000 break;
7001 #endif
7002 event_found = 1;
7003
7004 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7005
7006 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7007 goto out;
7008 }
7009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7010 }
7011
7012 #ifdef USE_GTK
7013
7014 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7015 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7016 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7017 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7018
7019 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7020 from all displays. */
7021
7022 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7023 {
7024 current_count = count;
7025 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7026
7027 gtk_main_iteration ();
7028
7029 count = current_count;
7030 current_count = -1;
7031 current_hold_quit = 0;
7032
7033 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7034 break;
7035 }
7036 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7037
7038 out:;
7039
7040 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7041 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7042 if (! event_found)
7043 {
7044 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7045 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7046 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7047 x_noop_count++;
7048 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7049 {
7050 x_noop_count=0;
7051
7052 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7053 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7054
7055 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7056
7057 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7058 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7059 }
7060 }
7061
7062 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7063 raise it now. */
7064 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7065 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7066 {
7067 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7068 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7069 }
7070
7071 --handling_signal;
7072 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7073
7074 return count;
7075 }
7076
7077
7078
7079 \f
7080 /***********************************************************************
7081 Text Cursor
7082 ***********************************************************************/
7083
7084 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7085 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7086
7087 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7088 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7089 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7090
7091 static void
7092 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7093 struct window *w;
7094 struct glyph_row *row;
7095 int area;
7096 GC gc;
7097 {
7098 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7099 XRectangle clip_rect;
7100 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7101
7102 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7103
7104 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7105 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7106 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7107 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7108 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7109
7110 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7111 }
7112
7113
7114 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7115
7116 static void
7117 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7118 struct window *w;
7119 struct glyph_row *row;
7120 {
7121 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7122 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7123 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7124 int x, y, wd, h;
7125 XGCValues xgcv;
7126 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7127 GC gc;
7128
7129 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7130 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7131 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7132 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7133 return;
7134
7135 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7136 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7137 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7138 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7139
7140 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7141 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7142 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7143 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7144 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7145 else
7146 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7147 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7148 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7149
7150 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7151 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7152 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7153 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7154 }
7155
7156
7157 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7158
7159 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7160 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7161 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7162 --gerd. */
7163
7164 static void
7165 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7166 struct window *w;
7167 struct glyph_row *row;
7168 int width;
7169 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7170 {
7171 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7172 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7173
7174 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7175 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7176 and mini-buffer. */
7177 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7178 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7179 return;
7180
7181 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7182 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7183 the bar might not be in the window. */
7184 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7185 {
7186 struct glyph_row *row;
7187 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7188 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7189 }
7190 else
7191 {
7192 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7193 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7194 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7195 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7196 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7197 XGCValues xgcv;
7198
7199 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7200 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7201 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7202 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7203 that the glyph is legible. */
7204 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7205 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7206 else
7207 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7208 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7209
7210 if (gc)
7211 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7212 else
7213 {
7214 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7215 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7216 }
7217
7218 if (width < 0)
7219 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7220 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7221
7222 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7223 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7224
7225 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7226 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7227 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7228 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7229 width, row->height);
7230 else
7231 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7232 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7233 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7234 row->height - width),
7235 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7236 width);
7237
7238 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7239 }
7240 }
7241
7242
7243 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7244
7245 static void
7246 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7247 struct frame *f;
7248 Cursor cursor;
7249 {
7250 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7251 }
7252
7253
7254 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7255
7256 static void
7257 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7258 struct frame *f;
7259 int x, y, width, height;
7260 {
7261 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7262 x, y, width, height, False);
7263 }
7264
7265
7266 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7267
7268 static void
7269 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7270 struct window *w;
7271 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7272 int x, y;
7273 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7274 int on_p, active_p;
7275 {
7276 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7277
7278 if (on_p)
7279 {
7280 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7281 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7282
7283 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7284 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7285 {
7286 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7287 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7288 }
7289 else
7290 switch (cursor_type)
7291 {
7292 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7293 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7294 break;
7295
7296 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7297 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7298 break;
7299
7300 case BAR_CURSOR:
7301 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7302 break;
7303
7304 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7305 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7306 break;
7307
7308 case NO_CURSOR:
7309 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7310 break;
7311
7312 default:
7313 abort ();
7314 }
7315
7316 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7317 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7318 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7319 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7320 #endif
7321 }
7322
7323 #ifndef XFlush
7324 if (updating_frame != f)
7325 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7326 #endif
7327 }
7328
7329 \f
7330 /* Icons. */
7331
7332 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7333
7334 int
7335 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7336 struct frame *f;
7337 Lisp_Object file;
7338 {
7339 int bitmap_id;
7340
7341 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7342 return 1;
7343
7344 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7345 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7346 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7347 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7348
7349 if (STRINGP (file))
7350 {
7351 #ifdef USE_GTK
7352 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7353 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7354 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7355 return 0;
7356 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7357 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7358 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7359 }
7360 else
7361 {
7362 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7363 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7364 {
7365 int rc = -1;
7366
7367 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7368 #ifdef USE_GTK
7369 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7370 return 0;
7371 #else
7372 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7373 if (rc != -1)
7374 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7375 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7376 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7377
7378 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7379 if (rc == -1)
7380 {
7381 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7382 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7383 if (rc == -1)
7384 return 1;
7385
7386 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7387 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7388 }
7389 }
7390
7391 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7392 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7393 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7394 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7395 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7396
7397 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7398 }
7399
7400 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7401 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7402
7403 return 0;
7404 }
7405
7406
7407 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7408 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7409
7410 int
7411 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7412 struct frame *f;
7413 char *icon_name;
7414 {
7415 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7416 return 1;
7417
7418 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7419 {
7420 XTextProperty text;
7421 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7422 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7423 text.format = 8;
7424 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7425 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7426 }
7427 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7428 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7429 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7430
7431 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7432 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7433 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7434 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7435
7436 return 0;
7437 }
7438 \f
7439 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7440
7441 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7442 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7443
7444 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7445
7446 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7447 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7448 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7449
7450 static void
7451 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7452 Display *display;
7453 XErrorEvent *error;
7454 {
7455 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7456 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7457 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7458 }
7459
7460 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7461 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7462 operating on.
7463
7464 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7465 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7466 stored in x_error_message_string.
7467
7468 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7469 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7470
7471 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7472
7473 void x_check_errors ();
7474 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7475
7476 int
7477 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7478 Display *dpy;
7479 {
7480 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7481
7482 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7483 XSync (dpy, False);
7484
7485 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7486 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7487 x_error_message_string));
7488
7489 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7490 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7491
7492 return count;
7493 }
7494
7495 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7496
7497 static Lisp_Object
7498 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7499 Lisp_Object old_val;
7500 {
7501 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7502 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7503
7504 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7505 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7506 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7507 {
7508 BLOCK_INPUT;
7509 XSync (dpy, False);
7510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7511 }
7512
7513 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7514 return Qnil;
7515 }
7516
7517 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7518 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7519 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7520
7521 void
7522 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7523 Display *dpy;
7524 char *format;
7525 {
7526 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7527 XSync (dpy, False);
7528
7529 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7530 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7531 }
7532
7533 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7534 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7535
7536 int
7537 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7538 Display *dpy;
7539 {
7540 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7541 XSync (dpy, False);
7542
7543 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7544 }
7545
7546 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7547
7548 void
7549 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7550 Display *dpy;
7551 {
7552 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7553 }
7554
7555 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7556 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7557 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7558 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7559
7560 void
7561 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7562 Display *dpy;
7563 int count;
7564 {
7565 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7566 }
7567
7568 #if 0
7569 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7570 x_trace_wire ()
7571 {
7572 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7573 }
7574 #endif /* ! 0 */
7575
7576 \f
7577 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7578 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7579 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7580 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7581 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7582
7583 static SIGTYPE
7584 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7585 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7586 {
7587 #ifdef USG
7588 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7589 must reestablish each time */
7590 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7591 #endif /* USG */
7592 }
7593
7594 \f
7595 /************************************************************************
7596 Handling X errors
7597 ************************************************************************/
7598
7599 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7600
7601 static char *error_msg;
7602
7603 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7604 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7605 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7606
7607 static void
7608 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7609 {
7610 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7611 exit (70);
7612 }
7613
7614 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7615 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7616
7617 static SIGTYPE
7618 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7619 Display *dpy;
7620 char *error_message;
7621 {
7622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7623 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7624 int count;
7625
7626 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7627 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7628 handling_signal = 0;
7629
7630 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7631 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7632 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7633 the original message here. */
7634 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7635
7636 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7637 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7638 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7639
7640 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7641 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7642 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7643
7644 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7645 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7646
7647 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7648 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7649 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7650
7651 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7652 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7653 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7654 if (dpyinfo)
7655 {
7656 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7657 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7658 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7659 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7660 }
7661 #endif
7662
7663 #ifdef USE_GTK
7664 if (dpyinfo)
7665 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7666 #endif
7667
7668 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7669 if (dpyinfo)
7670 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7671
7672 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7673 that are on the dead display. */
7674 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7675 {
7676 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7677 minibuf_frame
7678 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7679 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7680 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7681 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7682 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7683 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7684 }
7685
7686 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7687 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7688 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7689 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7690 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7691 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7692 {
7693 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7694 trying to find a replacement. */
7695 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7696 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7697 }
7698
7699 if (dpyinfo)
7700 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7701
7702 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7703
7704 if (x_display_list == 0)
7705 {
7706 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7707 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7708 exit (70);
7709 }
7710
7711 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7712 #ifdef SIGIO
7713 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7714 #endif
7715 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7716 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7717
7718 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7719 error ("%s", error_msg);
7720 }
7721
7722 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7723 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7724 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7725
7726 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7727 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7728
7729 static int
7730 x_error_handler (display, error)
7731 Display *display;
7732 XErrorEvent *error;
7733 {
7734 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7735 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7736 else
7737 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7738 return 0;
7739 }
7740
7741 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7742 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7743 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7744
7745 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7746
7747 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7748 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7749 #else
7750 #define NO_INLINE
7751 #endif
7752
7753 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7754
7755 #ifdef noinline
7756 #undef noinline
7757 #endif
7758
7759 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7760 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7761
7762 static void NO_INLINE
7763 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7764 Display *display;
7765 XErrorEvent *error;
7766 {
7767 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7768
7769 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7770 original error handler. */
7771
7772 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7773 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7774 buf, error->request_code);
7775 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7776 }
7777
7778
7779 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7780 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7781 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7782
7783 static int
7784 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7785 Display *display;
7786 {
7787 char buf[256];
7788
7789 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7790 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7791 return 0;
7792 }
7793 \f
7794 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7795
7796 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7797 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7798 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7799 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7800
7801 Lisp_Object
7802 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7803 struct frame *f;
7804 register char *fontname;
7805 {
7806 struct font_info *fontp
7807 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7808
7809 if (!fontp)
7810 return Qnil;
7811
7812 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7813 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7814 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7815
7816 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7817 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7818 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7819
7820 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7821
7822 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7823 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7824 {
7825 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7826 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7827 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7828 }
7829 else
7830 {
7831 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7832 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7833 }
7834
7835 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7836 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7837 {
7838 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7839 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7840 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7841 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7842 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7843 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7844
7845 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7846 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7847 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7848 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7849 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7850 }
7851
7852 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7853 }
7854
7855 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7856 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7857 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7858 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7859
7860 Lisp_Object
7861 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7862 struct frame *f;
7863 char *fontsetname;
7864 {
7865 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7866 Lisp_Object result;
7867
7868 if (fontset < 0)
7869 return Qnil;
7870
7871 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7872 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7873 to do. */
7874 return fontset_name (fontset);
7875
7876 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7877
7878 if (!STRINGP (result))
7879 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7880 return Qnil;
7881
7882 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7883 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7884
7885 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7886 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7887 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7888 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7889 #endif
7890
7891 return build_string (fontsetname);
7892 }
7893
7894 \f
7895 /***********************************************************************
7896 X Input Methods
7897 ***********************************************************************/
7898
7899 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7900
7901 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7902
7903 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7904 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7905 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7906
7907 static void
7908 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7909 XIM xim;
7910 XPointer client_data;
7911 XPointer call_data;
7912 {
7913 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7914 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7915
7916 BLOCK_INPUT;
7917
7918 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7919 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7920 {
7921 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7922 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7923 {
7924 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7925 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7926 }
7927 }
7928
7929 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7930 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7931 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7932 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7933 }
7934
7935 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7936
7937 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7938 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7939 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7940 #endif
7941
7942 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7943 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7944
7945 static void
7946 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7947 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7948 char *resource_name;
7949 {
7950 XIM xim;
7951
7952 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7953 if (use_xim)
7954 {
7955 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7956 EMACS_CLASS);
7957 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7958
7959 if (xim)
7960 {
7961 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7962 XIMCallback destroy;
7963 #endif
7964
7965 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7966 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7967
7968 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7969 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7970 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7971 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7972 #endif
7973 }
7974 }
7975
7976 else
7977 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7978 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7979 }
7980
7981
7982 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7983
7984 struct xim_inst_t
7985 {
7986 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7987 char *resource_name;
7988 };
7989
7990 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7991 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7992 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7993 when the callback was registered. */
7994
7995 static void
7996 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
7997 Display *display;
7998 XPointer client_data;
7999 XPointer call_data;
8000 {
8001 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8002 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8003
8004 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8005 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8006 return;
8007
8008 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8009
8010 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8011 as they have no XIC. */
8012 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8013 {
8014 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8015
8016 BLOCK_INPUT;
8017 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8018 {
8019 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8020
8021 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8022 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8023 {
8024 create_frame_xic (f);
8025 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8026 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8027 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8028 {
8029 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8030 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8031 }
8032 }
8033 }
8034
8035 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8040
8041
8042 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8043 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8044 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8045 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8046
8047 static void
8048 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8049 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8050 char *resource_name;
8051 {
8052 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8053 if (use_xim)
8054 {
8055 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8056 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8057 int len;
8058
8059 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8060 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8061 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8062 len = strlen (resource_name);
8063 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8064 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8065 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8066 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8067 xim_instantiate_callback,
8068 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8069 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8070 least, hence the configure test. */
8071 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8072 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8073 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8074 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8075 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8076
8077 }
8078 else
8079 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8080 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8081 }
8082
8083
8084 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8085
8086 static void
8087 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8088 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8089 {
8090 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8091 if (use_xim)
8092 {
8093 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8094 if (dpyinfo->display)
8095 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8096 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8097 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8098 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8099 if (dpyinfo->display)
8100 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8101 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8102 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8103 }
8104 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8105 }
8106
8107 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8108
8109
8110 \f
8111 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8112 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8113
8114 void
8115 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8116 struct frame *f;
8117 {
8118 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8119
8120 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8121 is already for the top-left corner. */
8122 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8123 return;
8124
8125 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8126 position that fits on the screen. */
8127 if (flags & XNegative)
8128 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8129 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8130
8131 {
8132 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8133
8134 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8135 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8136 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8137
8138 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8139 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8140 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8141 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8142 is right, though.
8143
8144 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8145 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8146
8147 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8148 #endif
8149
8150 if (flags & YNegative)
8151 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8152 }
8153
8154 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8155 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8156 so the flags should correspond. */
8157 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8158 }
8159
8160 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8161 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8162 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8163 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8164 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8165
8166 void
8167 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8168 struct frame *f;
8169 register int xoff, yoff;
8170 int change_gravity;
8171 {
8172 int modified_top, modified_left;
8173
8174 if (change_gravity > 0)
8175 {
8176 f->top_pos = yoff;
8177 f->left_pos = xoff;
8178 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8179 if (xoff < 0)
8180 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8181 if (yoff < 0)
8182 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8183 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8184 }
8185 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8186
8187 BLOCK_INPUT;
8188 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8189
8190 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8191 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8192
8193 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8194 {
8195 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8196 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8197 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8198 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8199 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8200 }
8201
8202 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8203 modified_left, modified_top);
8204
8205 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8206 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8207 {
8208 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8209 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8210 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8211 }
8212
8213 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8214 }
8215
8216 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8217 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8218 static void
8219 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8220 struct frame *f;
8221 {
8222 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8223 {
8224 int width, height, ign;
8225
8226 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8227
8228 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8229
8230 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8231 when setting WM manager hints.
8232 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8233 x_check_expected_move. */
8234 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8235 {
8236 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8237 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8238 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8239
8240 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8241 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8242 }
8243 }
8244 }
8245
8246 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8247 the window.
8248 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8249 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8250 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8251 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8252 static void
8253 x_check_expected_move (f)
8254 struct frame *f;
8255 {
8256 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8257 {
8258 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8259 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8260
8261 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8262 {
8263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8264 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8265 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8266
8267 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8268 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8269 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8270 }
8271 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8272 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8273
8274 /* Just do this once */
8275 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8276 }
8277 }
8278
8279
8280 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8281 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8282 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8283 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8284
8285 static void
8286 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8287 struct frame *f;
8288 int change_gravity;
8289 int cols, rows;
8290 {
8291 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8292
8293 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8294 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8295 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8296 ? 0
8297 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8298 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8299 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8300
8301 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8302
8303 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8304 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8305
8306 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8307 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8308
8309 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8310 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8311 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8312
8313 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8314 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8315 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8316 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8317
8318 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8319 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8320 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8321 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8322 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8323
8324 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8325 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8326 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8327 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8328 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8329
8330 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8331 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8332 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8333 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8334 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8335
8336 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8337 }
8338
8339
8340 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8341 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8342 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8343 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8344
8345 void
8346 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8347 struct frame *f;
8348 int change_gravity;
8349 int cols, rows;
8350 {
8351 BLOCK_INPUT;
8352
8353 #ifdef USE_GTK
8354 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8355 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8356 else
8357 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8358 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8359
8360 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8361 {
8362 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8363 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8364 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8365 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8366 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8367 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8368 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8369 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8370 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8371 }
8372 else
8373 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8374
8375 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8376
8377 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8378
8379 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8380
8381 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8382 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8383
8384 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8385 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8386 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8387 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8388 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8389
8390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8391 }
8392 \f
8393 /* Mouse warping. */
8394
8395 void
8396 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8397 struct frame *f;
8398 int x, y;
8399 {
8400 int pix_x, pix_y;
8401
8402 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8403 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8404
8405 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8406 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8407
8408 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8409 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8410
8411 BLOCK_INPUT;
8412
8413 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8414 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8415 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8416 }
8417
8418 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8419
8420 void
8421 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8422 struct frame *f;
8423 int pix_x, pix_y;
8424 {
8425 BLOCK_INPUT;
8426
8427 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8428 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8429 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8430 }
8431 \f
8432 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8433
8434 void
8435 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8436 struct frame *f;
8437 {
8438 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8439 x_raise_frame (f);
8440 #endif
8441 #if 0
8442 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8443 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8444 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8445 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8446 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8447 #endif /* ! 0 */
8448 }
8449
8450 void
8451 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8452 struct frame *f;
8453 {
8454 #if 0
8455 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8457 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8458 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8459 #endif /* ! 0 */
8460 }
8461
8462 /* Raise frame F. */
8463
8464 void
8465 x_raise_frame (f)
8466 struct frame *f;
8467 {
8468 if (f->async_visible)
8469 {
8470 BLOCK_INPUT;
8471 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8472 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8473 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8474 }
8475 }
8476
8477 /* Lower frame F. */
8478
8479 void
8480 x_lower_frame (f)
8481 struct frame *f;
8482 {
8483 if (f->async_visible)
8484 {
8485 BLOCK_INPUT;
8486 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8487 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8488 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8489 }
8490 }
8491
8492 static void
8493 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8494 FRAME_PTR f;
8495 int raise_flag;
8496 {
8497 if (raise_flag)
8498 x_raise_frame (f);
8499 else
8500 x_lower_frame (f);
8501 }
8502 \f
8503 /* Change of visibility. */
8504
8505 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8506 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8507 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8508 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8509 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8510 finishes with it. */
8511
8512 void
8513 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8514 struct frame *f;
8515 {
8516 Lisp_Object type;
8517 int original_top, original_left;
8518 int retry_count = 2;
8519
8520 retry:
8521
8522 BLOCK_INPUT;
8523
8524 type = x_icon_type (f);
8525 if (!NILP (type))
8526 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8527
8528 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8529 {
8530 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8531 call x_set_offset a second time
8532 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8533 before the window gets really visible. */
8534 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8535 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8536 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8537
8538 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8539
8540 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8541 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8542 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8543 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8544 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8545 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8546 #ifdef USE_GTK
8547 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8548 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8549 #else
8550 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8551 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8552 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8553 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8554 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8555 to come back ok without this. */
8556 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8557 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8558 #endif
8559 }
8560
8561 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8562
8563 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8564 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8565 so that incoming events are handled. */
8566 {
8567 Lisp_Object frame;
8568 int count;
8569 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8570 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8571 will set it when they are handled. */
8572 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8573
8574 original_left = f->left_pos;
8575 original_top = f->top_pos;
8576
8577 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8578 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8579
8580 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8581
8582 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8583 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8584 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8585 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8586
8587 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8588 because the window manager may choose the position
8589 and we don't want to override it. */
8590
8591 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8592 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8593 && previously_visible)
8594 {
8595 Drawable rootw;
8596 int x, y;
8597 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8598
8599 BLOCK_INPUT;
8600
8601 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8602 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8603 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8604 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8605 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8606 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8607 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8608 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8609 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8610
8611 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8612 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8613 original_left, original_top);
8614
8615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8616 }
8617
8618 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8619
8620 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8621 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8622 MapNotify at all.. */
8623 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8624 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8625 {
8626 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8627 x_sync (f);
8628
8629 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8630 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8631 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8632 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8633 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8634 probably a bug. */
8635 if (input_polling_used ())
8636 {
8637 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8638 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8639 handler reset it. */
8640 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8641 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8642 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8643 poll_for_input_1 ();
8644 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8645 }
8646
8647 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8648 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8649 }
8650
8651 /* 2000-09-28: In
8652
8653 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8654 (iconify-frame f)
8655 (raise-frame f))
8656
8657 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8658 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8659 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8660 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8661
8662 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8663 goto retry;
8664 }
8665 }
8666
8667 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8668
8669 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8670
8671 void
8672 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8673 struct frame *f;
8674 {
8675 Window window;
8676
8677 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8678 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8679
8680 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8681 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8682 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8683
8684 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8685 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8686 return;
8687 #endif
8688
8689 BLOCK_INPUT;
8690
8691 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8692 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8693 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8694 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8695 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8696 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8697
8698 #ifdef USE_GTK
8699 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8700 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8701 else
8702 #endif
8703 {
8704 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8705
8706 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8707 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8708 {
8709 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8710 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8711 }
8712 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8713
8714 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8715 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8716 {
8717 XEvent unmap;
8718
8719 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8720 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8721 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8722 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8723 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8724 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8725 False,
8726 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8727 &unmap))
8728 {
8729 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8730 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8731 }
8732 }
8733
8734 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8735 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8736 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8737 }
8738
8739 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8740 just by the event that we get from the server.
8741 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8742 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8743 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8744 f->visible = 0;
8745 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8746 f->async_visible = 0;
8747 f->async_iconified = 0;
8748
8749 x_sync (f);
8750
8751 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8752 }
8753
8754 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8755
8756 void
8757 x_iconify_frame (f)
8758 struct frame *f;
8759 {
8760 int result;
8761 Lisp_Object type;
8762
8763 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8764 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8766
8767 if (f->async_iconified)
8768 return;
8769
8770 BLOCK_INPUT;
8771
8772 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8773
8774 type = x_icon_type (f);
8775 if (!NILP (type))
8776 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8777
8778 #ifdef USE_GTK
8779 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8780 {
8781 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8782 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8783
8784 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8785 f->iconified = 1;
8786 f->visible = 1;
8787 f->async_iconified = 1;
8788 f->async_visible = 0;
8789 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8790 return;
8791 }
8792 #endif
8793
8794 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8795
8796 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8797 {
8798 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8799 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8800 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8801 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8802 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8803 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8804 so we have to record it here. */
8805 f->iconified = 1;
8806 f->visible = 1;
8807 f->async_iconified = 1;
8808 f->async_visible = 0;
8809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8810 return;
8811 }
8812
8813 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8814 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8815 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8816 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8817
8818 if (!result)
8819 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8820
8821 f->async_iconified = 1;
8822 f->async_visible = 0;
8823
8824
8825 BLOCK_INPUT;
8826 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8827 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8828 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8829
8830 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8831 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8832 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8833 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8834
8835 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8836 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8837
8838 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8839 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8840 {
8841 XEvent message;
8842
8843 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8844 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8845 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8846 message.xclient.format = 32;
8847 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8848
8849 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8850 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8851 False,
8852 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8853 &message))
8854 {
8855 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8856 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8857 }
8858 }
8859
8860 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8861 IconicState. */
8862 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8863
8864 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8865 {
8866 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8867 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8868 }
8869
8870 f->async_iconified = 1;
8871 f->async_visible = 0;
8872
8873 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8874 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8875 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8876 }
8877
8878 \f
8879 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8880
8881 void
8882 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8883 struct frame *f;
8884 {
8885 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8886 Lisp_Object bar;
8887 struct scroll_bar *b;
8888
8889 BLOCK_INPUT;
8890
8891 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8892 commands to the X server. */
8893 if (dpyinfo->display)
8894 {
8895 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8896 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8897
8898 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8899 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8900 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8901 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8902 toolkit scroll bars. */
8903 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8904 {
8905 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8906 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8907 }
8908 #endif
8909
8910 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8911 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8912 free_frame_xic (f);
8913 #endif
8914
8915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8916 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8917 {
8918 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8919 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8920 }
8921 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8922 we are using a toolkit. */
8923 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8924 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8925
8926 free_frame_menubar (f);
8927 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8928
8929 #ifdef USE_GTK
8930 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8931 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8932 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8933 {
8934 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8935 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8936 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8937 }
8938 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8939
8940 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8941 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8942 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8943
8944 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8945 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8946 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8947 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8948 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8949 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8950
8951 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8952 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8953 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8954 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8955 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8956 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8957 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8958 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8959 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8960 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8961 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8962 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8963 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8964 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8965 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
8966
8967 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
8968 free_frame_faces (f);
8969
8970 x_free_gcs (f);
8971 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8972 }
8973
8974 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
8975 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
8976
8977 xfree (f->output_data.x);
8978 f->output_data.x = NULL;
8979
8980 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
8981 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
8982 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
8983 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
8984 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
8985 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8986
8987 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
8988 {
8989 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
8990 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
8991 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
8992 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
8993 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
8994 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
8995 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
8996 }
8997
8998 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8999 }
9000
9001
9002 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9003
9004 void
9005 x_destroy_window (f)
9006 struct frame *f;
9007 {
9008 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9009
9010 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9011 commands to the X server. */
9012 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9013 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9014
9015 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9016 }
9017
9018 \f
9019 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9020
9021 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9022 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9023 that the window now has.
9024 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9025 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9026 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9027
9028 #ifndef USE_GTK
9029 void
9030 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9031 struct frame *f;
9032 long flags;
9033 int user_position;
9034 {
9035 XSizeHints size_hints;
9036
9037 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9038 Arg al[2];
9039 int ac = 0;
9040 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9041 #endif
9042
9043 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9044
9045 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9046 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9047
9048 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9049 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9050
9051 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9052 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9053 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9054 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9055 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9056 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9057 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9058 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9059 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9060 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9061
9062 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9063 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9064 size_hints.max_width
9065 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9066 size_hints.max_height
9067 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9068
9069 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9070
9071 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9072 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9073 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9074 {
9075 int base_width, base_height;
9076 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9077
9078 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9079 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9080
9081 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9082
9083 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9084 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9085 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9086 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9087 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9088
9089 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9090 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9091 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9092
9093 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9094 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9095 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9096 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9097 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9098 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9099 #else
9100 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9101 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9102 #endif
9103 }
9104
9105 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9106 if (flags)
9107 {
9108 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9109 goto no_read;
9110 }
9111 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9112
9113 {
9114 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9115 long supplied_return;
9116 int value;
9117
9118 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9119 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9120 &supplied_return);
9121 #else
9122 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9123 #endif
9124
9125 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9126 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9127 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9128 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9129 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9130 #endif
9131
9132 if (flags)
9133 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9134 else
9135 {
9136 if (value == 0)
9137 hints.flags = 0;
9138 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9139 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9140 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9141 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9142 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9143 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9144 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9145 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9146 }
9147 }
9148
9149 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9150 no_read:
9151 #endif
9152
9153 #ifdef PWinGravity
9154 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9155 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9156
9157 if (user_position)
9158 {
9159 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9160 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9161 }
9162 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9163
9164 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9165 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9166 #else
9167 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9168 #endif
9169 }
9170 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9171
9172 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9173
9174 void
9175 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9176 struct frame *f;
9177 int state;
9178 {
9179 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9180 Arg al[1];
9181
9182 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9183 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9184 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9185 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9186
9187 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9188 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9189
9190 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9191 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9192 }
9193
9194 void
9195 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9196 struct frame *f;
9197 int pixmap_id;
9198 {
9199 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9200
9201 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9202 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9203 #endif
9204
9205 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9206 {
9207 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9208 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9209 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9210 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9211 }
9212 else
9213 {
9214 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9215 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9216 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9217 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9218 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9219 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9220 best to explicitly give up. */
9221 #if 0
9222 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9223 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9224 #else
9225 return;
9226 #endif
9227 }
9228
9229
9230 #ifdef USE_GTK
9231 {
9232 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9233 return;
9234 }
9235
9236 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9237
9238 {
9239 Arg al[1];
9240 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9241 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9242 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9243 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9244 }
9245
9246 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9247
9248 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9249 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9250
9251 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9252 }
9253
9254 void
9255 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9256 struct frame *f;
9257 int icon_x, icon_y;
9258 {
9259 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9260
9261 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9262 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9263 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9264
9265 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9266 }
9267
9268 \f
9269 /***********************************************************************
9270 Fonts
9271 ***********************************************************************/
9272
9273 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9274
9275 struct font_info *
9276 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9277 FRAME_PTR f;
9278 int font_idx;
9279 {
9280 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9281 }
9282
9283
9284 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9285
9286 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9287 to be listed.
9288
9289 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9290
9291 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9292 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9293 on how many fonts to match. */
9294
9295 Lisp_Object
9296 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9297 struct frame *f;
9298 Lisp_Object pattern;
9299 int size;
9300 int maxnames;
9301 {
9302 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9303 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9304 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9305 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9306 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9307 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9308 int count;
9309 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9310
9311 if (size < 0)
9312 {
9313 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9314 size = 0;
9315 }
9316
9317 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9318 if (NILP (patterns))
9319 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9320
9321 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9322 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9323 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9324
9325 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9326 {
9327 int num_fonts;
9328 char **names = NULL;
9329
9330 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9331 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9332 The cache is an alist of the form:
9333 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9334 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9335 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9336 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9337 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9338 if (!NILP (list))
9339 {
9340 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9341 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9342 goto label_cached;
9343 }
9344
9345 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9346
9347 BLOCK_INPUT;
9348 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9349
9350 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9351 {
9352 XFontStruct *font;
9353 unsigned long value;
9354
9355 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9356 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9357 {
9358 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9359 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9360 font = NULL;
9361 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9362 }
9363
9364 if (font
9365 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9366 {
9367 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9368 int len = strlen (name);
9369 char *tmp;
9370
9371 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9372 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9373 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9374 if (len == 0)
9375 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9376 else
9377 {
9378 num_fonts = 1;
9379 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9380 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9381 simple var. */
9382 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9383 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9384 XFree (name);
9385 }
9386 }
9387 else
9388 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9389
9390 if (font)
9391 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9392 }
9393
9394 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9395 {
9396 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9397 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9398 if (maxnames < 0)
9399 {
9400 int limit;
9401
9402 for (limit = 500;;)
9403 {
9404 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9405 if (num_fonts == limit)
9406 {
9407 BLOCK_INPUT;
9408 XFreeFontNames (names);
9409 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9410 limit *= 2;
9411 }
9412 else
9413 break;
9414 }
9415 }
9416 else
9417 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9418 &num_fonts);
9419
9420 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9421 {
9422 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9423 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9424 names = NULL;
9425 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9426 }
9427 }
9428
9429 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9430 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9431
9432 if (names)
9433 {
9434 int i;
9435
9436 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9437 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9438 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9439 {
9440 int width = 0;
9441 char *p = names[i];
9442 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9443
9444 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9445 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9446 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9447 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9448 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9449 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9450 while (*p)
9451 if (*p++ == '-')
9452 {
9453 dashes++;
9454 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9455 width = atoi (p);
9456 else if (dashes == 9)
9457 resx = atoi (p);
9458 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9459 average_width = atoi (p);
9460 }
9461
9462 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9463 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9464 {
9465 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9466 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9467 {
9468 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9469 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9470 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9471 >= 0))
9472 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9473 width of this font. */
9474 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9475 else
9476 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9477 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9478 }
9479 }
9480 }
9481
9482 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9483 {
9484 BLOCK_INPUT;
9485 XFreeFontNames (names);
9486 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9487 }
9488 }
9489
9490 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9491 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9492 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9493
9494 label_cached:
9495 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9496
9497 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9498 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9499 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9500 {
9501 int found_size;
9502
9503 tem = XCAR (list);
9504
9505 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9506 continue;
9507 if (!size)
9508 {
9509 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9510 continue;
9511 }
9512
9513 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9514 {
9515 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9516 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9517 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9518
9519 BLOCK_INPUT;
9520 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9521 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9522 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9523 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9524 {
9525 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9526 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9527 thisinfo = NULL;
9528 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9529 }
9530 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9531 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9532
9533 if (thisinfo)
9534 {
9535 XSETCDR (tem,
9536 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9537 ? make_number (0)
9538 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9539 BLOCK_INPUT;
9540 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9541 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9542 }
9543 else
9544 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9545 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9546 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9547 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9548 }
9549
9550 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9551 if (found_size == size)
9552 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9553 else if (found_size > 0)
9554 {
9555 if (NILP (second_best))
9556 second_best = tem;
9557 else if (found_size < size)
9558 {
9559 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9560 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9561 second_best = tem;
9562 }
9563 else
9564 {
9565 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9566 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9567 second_best = tem;
9568 }
9569 }
9570 }
9571 if (!NILP (newlist))
9572 break;
9573 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9574 {
9575 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9576 break;
9577 }
9578 }
9579
9580 return newlist;
9581 }
9582
9583
9584 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9585
9586 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9587 font table. */
9588
9589 static void
9590 x_check_font (f, font)
9591 struct frame *f;
9592 XFontStruct *font;
9593 {
9594 int i;
9595 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9596
9597 xassert (font != NULL);
9598
9599 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9600 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9601 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9602 break;
9603
9604 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9605 }
9606
9607 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9608
9609 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9610 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9611 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9612 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9613 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9614
9615 static INLINE void
9616 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9617 XFontStruct *font;
9618 int *w, *h;
9619 {
9620 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9621 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9622
9623 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9624 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9625 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9626 if (*w <= 0)
9627 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9628 }
9629
9630
9631 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9632 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9633 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9634 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9635 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9636
9637 static int
9638 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9639 struct frame *f;
9640 {
9641 int i;
9642 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9643 XFontStruct *font;
9644 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9645 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9646
9647 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9648 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9649
9650 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9651 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9652 {
9653 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9654 int w, h;
9655
9656 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9657 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9658 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9659
9660 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9661 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9662 }
9663
9664 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9665 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9666
9667 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9668 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9669 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9670 }
9671
9672
9673 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9674 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9675 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9676 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9677
9678 struct font_info *
9679 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9680 struct frame *f;
9681 register char *fontname;
9682 int size;
9683 {
9684 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9685 Lisp_Object font_names;
9686 int count;
9687
9688 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9689 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9690 we already have by comparing names. */
9691 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9692
9693 if (!NILP (font_names))
9694 {
9695 Lisp_Object tail;
9696 int i;
9697
9698 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9699 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9700 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9701 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9702 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9703 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9704 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9705 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9706 }
9707
9708 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9709 {
9710 char *full_name;
9711 XFontStruct *font;
9712 struct font_info *fontp;
9713 unsigned long value;
9714 int i;
9715
9716 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9717 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9718 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9719 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9720 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9721 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9722 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9723
9724 BLOCK_INPUT;
9725 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9726 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9727 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9728 {
9729 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9730 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9731 font = NULL;
9732 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9733 }
9734 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9735 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9736 if (!font)
9737 return NULL;
9738
9739 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9740 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9741 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9742 break;
9743
9744 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9745 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9746 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9747 {
9748 int sz;
9749 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9750 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9751 dpyinfo->font_table
9752 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9753 }
9754
9755 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9756 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9757 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9758
9759 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9760 BLOCK_INPUT;
9761 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9762 fontp->font = font;
9763 fontp->font_idx = i;
9764 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9765 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9766
9767 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9768 {
9769 /* Fixed width font. */
9770 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9771 }
9772 else
9773 {
9774 XChar2b char2b;
9775 XCharStruct *pcm;
9776
9777 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9778 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9779 if (pcm)
9780 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9781 else
9782 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9783
9784 fontp->average_width
9785 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9786 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9787 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9788 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9789 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9790 {
9791 if (pcm)
9792 {
9793 int width = pcm->width;
9794 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9795 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9796 width += pcm->width;
9797 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9798 }
9799 else
9800 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9801 }
9802 }
9803
9804 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9805 full_name = 0;
9806 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9807 {
9808 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9809 char *p = name;
9810 int dashes = 0;
9811
9812 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9813 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9814 so don't use it.
9815 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9816 stored in them. */
9817 while (*p)
9818 {
9819 if (*p == '-')
9820 dashes++;
9821 p++;
9822 }
9823
9824 if (dashes >= 13)
9825 {
9826 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9827 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9828 }
9829
9830 XFree (name);
9831 }
9832
9833 if (full_name != 0)
9834 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9835 else
9836 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9837
9838 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9839 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9840
9841 if (NILP (font_names))
9842 {
9843 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9844 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9845 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9846 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9847 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9848 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9849 Qnil);
9850
9851 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9852 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9853 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9854 make_number (fontp->size)),
9855 Qnil)),
9856 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9857 if (full_name)
9858 {
9859 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9860 Qnil);
9861 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9862 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9863 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9864 make_number (fontp->size)),
9865 Qnil)),
9866 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9867 }
9868 }
9869
9870 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9871 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9872 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9873 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9874 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9875 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9876 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9877 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9878 fontp->encoding[1]
9879 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9880 /* 1-byte font */
9881 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9882 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9883 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9884 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9885 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9886 /* 2-byte font */
9887 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9888 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9889 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9890 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9891 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9892 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9893 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9894 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9895 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9896 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9897 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9898 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9899 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9900
9901 fontp->baseline_offset
9902 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9903 ? (long) value : 0);
9904 fontp->relative_compose
9905 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9906 ? (long) value : 0);
9907 fontp->default_ascent
9908 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9909 ? (long) value : 0);
9910
9911 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9912 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9913 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9914 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9915 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9916 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9917 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9918 return fontp;
9919 }
9920 }
9921
9922
9923 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9924 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9925
9926 struct font_info *
9927 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9928 struct frame *f;
9929 register char *fontname;
9930 {
9931 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9932 int i;
9933
9934 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9935 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9936 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9937 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9938 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9939 return NULL;
9940 }
9941
9942
9943 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9944 `encoder' of the structure. */
9945
9946 void
9947 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9948 struct font_info *fontp;
9949 {
9950 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9951
9952 elt = Qnil;
9953 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9954 {
9955 elt = XCAR (list);
9956 if (CONSP (elt)
9957 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9958 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9959 >= 0)
9960 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9961 >= 0)))
9962 break;
9963 }
9964
9965 if (! NILP (list))
9966 {
9967 struct ccl_program *ccl
9968 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9969
9970 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9971 xfree (ccl);
9972 else
9973 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9974 }
9975 }
9976
9977
9978 \f
9979 /***********************************************************************
9980 Initialization
9981 ***********************************************************************/
9982
9983 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9984 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9985 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9986 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9987
9988 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9989 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9990 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9991
9992 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9993 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9994 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9995 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9996 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9997 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9998 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9999 };
10000 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10001
10002 static int x_initialized;
10003
10004 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10005 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10006 the screen number from the server number. */
10007 static int
10008 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10009 const char *name1, *name2;
10010 {
10011 int seen_colon = 0;
10012 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10013 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10014 int length_until_period = 0;
10015
10016 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10017 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10018 length_until_period++;
10019
10020 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10021 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10022 name1 += 4;
10023 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10024 name2 += 4;
10025 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10026 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10027 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10028 name1 += system_name_length;
10029 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10030 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10031 name2 += system_name_length;
10032 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10033 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10034 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10035 name1 += length_until_period;
10036 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10037 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10038 name2 += length_until_period;
10039
10040 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10041 {
10042 if (*name1 == ':')
10043 seen_colon++;
10044 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10045 return 1;
10046 }
10047 return (seen_colon
10048 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10049 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10050 }
10051 #endif
10052
10053 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10054 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10055 to 5. */
10056 static void
10057 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10058 unsigned long mask;
10059 int *bits;
10060 int *offset;
10061 {
10062 int nr = 0;
10063 int off = 0;
10064
10065 while (!(mask & 1))
10066 {
10067 off++;
10068 mask >>= 1;
10069 }
10070
10071 while (mask & 1)
10072 {
10073 nr++;
10074 mask >>= 1;
10075 }
10076
10077 *offset = off;
10078 *bits = nr;
10079 }
10080
10081 struct x_display_info *
10082 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10083 Lisp_Object display_name;
10084 char *xrm_option;
10085 char *resource_name;
10086 {
10087 int connection;
10088 Display *dpy;
10089 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10090 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10091
10092 BLOCK_INPUT;
10093
10094 if (!x_initialized)
10095 {
10096 x_initialize ();
10097 ++x_initialized;
10098 }
10099
10100 #ifdef USE_GTK
10101 {
10102 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10103 int argc;
10104 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10105 char **argv2 = argv;
10106 GdkAtom atom;
10107
10108 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10109 {
10110 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10111 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10112 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10113 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10114 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10115 }
10116 else
10117 {
10118 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10119 argv[argc] = 0;
10120
10121 argc = 0;
10122 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10123
10124 if (! NILP (display_name))
10125 {
10126 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10127 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10128 }
10129
10130 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10131 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10132
10133 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10134 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10135 #endif
10136
10137 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10138
10139 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10140 fixup_locale ();
10141 xg_initialize ();
10142
10143 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10144
10145 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10146 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10147
10148 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10149 {
10150 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10151 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10152 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10153
10154 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10155 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10156 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10157
10158 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10159 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10160
10161 UNGCPRO;
10162 }
10163
10164 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10165 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10166 }
10167 }
10168 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10169 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10170 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10171 errors with X11R5:
10172 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10173 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10174 So let's not use it until R6. */
10175 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10176 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10177 #endif
10178
10179 {
10180 int argc = 0;
10181 char *argv[3];
10182
10183 argv[0] = "";
10184 argc = 1;
10185 if (xrm_option)
10186 {
10187 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10188 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10189 }
10190 turn_on_atimers (0);
10191 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10192 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10193 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10194 &argc, argv);
10195 turn_on_atimers (1);
10196
10197 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10198 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10199 fixup_locale ();
10200 #endif
10201 }
10202
10203 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10204 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10205 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10206 #endif
10207 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10208 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10209 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10210
10211 /* Detect failure. */
10212 if (dpy == 0)
10213 {
10214 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10215 return 0;
10216 }
10217
10218 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10219
10220 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10221 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10222
10223 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10224 {
10225 struct x_display_info *share;
10226 Lisp_Object tail;
10227
10228 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10229 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10230 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10231 SDATA (display_name)))
10232 break;
10233 if (share)
10234 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10235 else
10236 {
10237 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10238 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10239 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10240 {
10241 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10243 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10244 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10245 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10246 BLOCK_INPUT;
10247 }
10248
10249 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10250 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10251 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10252 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10253 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10254 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10255 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10256 }
10257 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10258 }
10259 #endif
10260
10261 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10262 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10263 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10264
10265 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10266 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10267 x_display_name_list);
10268 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10269
10270 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10271
10272 #if 0
10273 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10274 #endif /* ! 0 */
10275
10276 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10277 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10278 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10279 + 2);
10280 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10281 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10282
10283 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10284 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10285
10286 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10287 #ifdef USE_GTK
10288 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10289 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10290 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10291
10292 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10293 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10294
10295 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10296 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10297 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10298 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10299 #else
10300 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10301 #endif
10302 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10303 all versions. */
10304 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10305
10306 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10307 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10308 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10309 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10310 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10311 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10312 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10313 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10317 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10318 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10319 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10322 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10323 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10327 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10329 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10330 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10338 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10339
10340 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10341 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10343
10344 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10345 {
10346 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10347 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10348 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10349 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10350 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10351 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10352 }
10353
10354 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10355 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10356 {
10357 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10358 {
10359 Lisp_Object value;
10360 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10361 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10362 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10363 Qnil, Qnil);
10364 if (STRINGP (value)
10365 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10366 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10367 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10368 }
10369 }
10370 else
10371 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10372 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10373
10374 {
10375 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10376 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10377 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10378 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10379 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10380 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10381 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10382 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10383 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10384 }
10385
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10418 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10419 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10420 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10421 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10422 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10423 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10425 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10426 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10427 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10428 /* For properties of font. */
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10431 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10432 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10433 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10434 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10435 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10436 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10438 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10439
10440 /* Ghostscript support. */
10441 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10442 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10443
10444 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10445 False);
10446
10447 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10448
10449 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10450 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10451
10452 {
10453 char null_bits[1];
10454
10455 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10456
10457 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10458 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10459 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10460 1);
10461 }
10462
10463 {
10464 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10465 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10466 dpyinfo->gray
10467 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10468 gray_bitmap_bits,
10469 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10470 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10471 }
10472
10473 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10474 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10475 #endif
10476
10477 #ifdef subprocesses
10478 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10479 if (connection != 0)
10480 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10481 #endif
10482
10483 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10484 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10485 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10486 /* stdin is a socket here */
10487 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10488 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10489 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10490 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10491 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10492 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10493
10494 #ifdef SIGIO
10495 if (interrupt_input)
10496 init_sigio (connection);
10497 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10498
10499 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10500 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10501 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10502 so that Xt does not crash. */
10503 {
10504 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10505 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10506 Font font;
10507 int count;
10508
10509 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10510 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10511 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10512 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10513 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10514 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10515 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10516 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10517 abort ();
10518 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10519 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10520 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10521 }
10522 #endif
10523 #endif
10524
10525 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10526 for debugging X code. */
10527 {
10528 Lisp_Object value;
10529 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10530 build_string ("synchronous"),
10531 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10532 Qnil, Qnil);
10533 if (STRINGP (value)
10534 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10535 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10536 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10537 }
10538
10539 {
10540 Lisp_Object value;
10541 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10542 build_string ("useXIM"),
10543 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10544 Qnil, Qnil);
10545 #ifdef USE_XIM
10546 if (STRINGP (value)
10547 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10548 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10549 use_xim = 0;
10550 #else
10551 if (STRINGP (value)
10552 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10553 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10554 use_xim = 1;
10555 #endif
10556 }
10557
10558 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10559 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10560 if (x_initialized == 1)
10561 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10562 #endif
10563
10564 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10565
10566 return dpyinfo;
10567 }
10568 \f
10569 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10570 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10571
10572 void
10573 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10574 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10575 {
10576 int i;
10577
10578 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10579
10580 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10581 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10582 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10583 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10584 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10585 else
10586 {
10587 Lisp_Object tail;
10588
10589 tail = x_display_name_list;
10590 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10591 {
10592 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10593 {
10594 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10595 break;
10596 }
10597 tail = XCDR (tail);
10598 }
10599 }
10600
10601 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10602 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10603
10604 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10605 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10606 else
10607 {
10608 struct x_display_info *tail;
10609
10610 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10611 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10612 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10613 }
10614
10615 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10616 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10617 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10618 #endif
10619 #endif
10620 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10621 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10622 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10623 #endif
10624 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10625 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10626 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10627 #endif
10628
10629 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10630 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10631 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10632 {
10633 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10634 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10635 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10636 }
10637
10638 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10639 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10640
10641 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10642 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10643 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10644 xfree (dpyinfo);
10645 }
10646
10647 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10648
10649 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10650 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10651 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10652 that slows us down. */
10653
10654 static void
10655 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10656 struct atimer *timer;
10657 {
10658 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10659 {
10660 BLOCK_INPUT;
10661 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10662 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10663 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10664 }
10665 }
10666
10667 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10668
10669 \f
10670 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10671
10672 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10673
10674 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10675 {
10676 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10677 x_produce_glyphs,
10678 x_write_glyphs,
10679 x_insert_glyphs,
10680 x_clear_end_of_line,
10681 x_scroll_run,
10682 x_after_update_window_line,
10683 x_update_window_begin,
10684 x_update_window_end,
10685 x_cursor_to,
10686 x_flush,
10687 #ifdef XFlush
10688 x_flush,
10689 #else
10690 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10691 #endif
10692 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10693 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10694 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10695 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10696 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10697 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10698 x_per_char_metric,
10699 x_encode_char,
10700 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10701 x_draw_glyph_string,
10702 x_define_frame_cursor,
10703 x_clear_frame_area,
10704 x_draw_window_cursor,
10705 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10706 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10707 };
10708
10709 void
10710 x_initialize ()
10711 {
10712 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10713
10714 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10715 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10716 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10717 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10718 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10719 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10720 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10721 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10722 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10723 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10724 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10725 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10726 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10727 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10728 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10729 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10730 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10731 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10732
10733 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10734 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10735 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10736 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10737 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10738 off the bottom */
10739 baud_rate = 19200;
10740
10741 x_noop_count = 0;
10742 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10743 any_help_event_p = 0;
10744 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10745
10746 #ifdef USE_GTK
10747 current_count = -1;
10748 #endif
10749
10750 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10751 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10752
10753 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10754 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10755
10756 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10757
10758 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10759 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10760 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10761 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10762 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10763 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10764 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10765
10766 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10767
10768 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10769 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10770 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10771 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10772 widgets don't behave normally. */
10773 {
10774 EMACS_TIME interval;
10775 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10776 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10777 }
10778 #endif
10779
10780 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10781 #ifndef USE_GTK
10782 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10783 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10784 #endif
10785 #endif
10786
10787 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10788 original error handler. */
10789 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10790 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10791
10792 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10793 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10794 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10795 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10796
10797 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10798 }
10799
10800
10801 void
10802 syms_of_xterm ()
10803 {
10804 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10805 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10806
10807 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10808 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10809
10810 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10811 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10812
10813 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10814 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10815
10816 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10817 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10818 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10819 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10820
10821 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10822 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10823
10824 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10825 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10826 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10827 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10828 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10829 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10830 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10831
10832 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10833 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10834 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10835 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10836 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10837 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10838 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10839 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10840 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10841
10842 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10843 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10844 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10845 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10846 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10847 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10848 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10849 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10850 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10851 #elif USE_GTK
10852 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10853 #else
10854 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10855 #endif
10856 #else
10857 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10858 #endif
10859
10860 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10861 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10862
10863 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10864 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10865 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10866 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10867 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10868 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10869 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10870 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10871 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10872
10873 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10874 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10875 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10876 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10877 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10878 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10879
10880 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10881 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10882 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10883 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10884 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10885 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10886
10887 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10888 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10889 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10890 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10891 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10892 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10893
10894 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10895 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10896 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10897 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10898 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10899 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10900
10901 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10902 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10903 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10904 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10905 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10906 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10907 }
10908
10909 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10910
10911 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10912 (do not change this comment) */